blob: 334cb68772c611d57cab0f3c27e43cc018296c44 [file] [log] [blame]
Misha Brukmandaa4cb02004-03-01 17:47:27 +00001<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN"
2 "http://www.w3.org/TR/html4/strict.dtd">
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003<html>
4<head>
5 <title>LLVM Assembly Language Reference Manual</title>
Reid Spencer3921c742004-08-26 20:44:00 +00006 <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=utf-8">
7 <meta name="author" content="Chris Lattner">
8 <meta name="description"
9 content="LLVM Assembly Language Reference Manual.">
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +000010 <link rel="stylesheet" href="llvm.css" type="text/css">
11</head>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +000012
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +000013<body>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +000014
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +000015<div class="doc_title"> LLVM Language Reference Manual </div>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +000016<ol>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +000017 <li><a href="#abstract">Abstract</a></li>
18 <li><a href="#introduction">Introduction</a></li>
19 <li><a href="#identifiers">Identifiers</a></li>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +000020 <li><a href="#highlevel">High Level Structure</a>
21 <ol>
22 <li><a href="#modulestructure">Module Structure</a></li>
Bill Wendling3d10a5a2009-07-20 01:03:30 +000023 <li><a href="#linkage">Linkage Types</a>
24 <ol>
Bill Wendling987e7eb2009-07-20 02:41:50 +000025 <li><a href="#linkage_private">'<tt>private</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
26 <li><a href="#linkage_linker_private">'<tt>linker_private</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
27 <li><a href="#linkage_internal">'<tt>internal</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
28 <li><a href="#linkage_available_externally">'<tt>available_externally</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
29 <li><a href="#linkage_linkonce">'<tt>linkonce</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
30 <li><a href="#linkage_common">'<tt>common</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
31 <li><a href="#linkage_weak">'<tt>weak</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
32 <li><a href="#linkage_appending">'<tt>appending</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
33 <li><a href="#linkage_externweak">'<tt>extern_weak</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
34 <li><a href="#linkage_linkonce">'<tt>linkonce_odr</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
35 <li><a href="#linkage_weak">'<tt>weak_odr</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
36 <li><a href="#linkage_external">'<tt>externally visible</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
37 <li><a href="#linkage_dllimport">'<tt>dllimport</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
38 <li><a href="#linkage_dllexport">'<tt>dllexport</tt>' Linkage</a></li>
Bill Wendling3d10a5a2009-07-20 01:03:30 +000039 </ol>
40 </li>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +000041 <li><a href="#callingconv">Calling Conventions</a></li>
Chris Lattnere7886e42009-01-11 20:53:49 +000042 <li><a href="#namedtypes">Named Types</a></li>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +000043 <li><a href="#globalvars">Global Variables</a></li>
Chris Lattner4e9aba72006-01-23 23:23:47 +000044 <li><a href="#functionstructure">Functions</a></li>
Dan Gohman0e451ce2008-10-14 16:51:45 +000045 <li><a href="#aliasstructure">Aliases</a></li>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +000046 <li><a href="#paramattrs">Parameter Attributes</a></li>
Devang Patel2c9c3e72008-09-26 23:51:19 +000047 <li><a href="#fnattrs">Function Attributes</a></li>
Gordon Henriksen80a75bf2007-12-10 03:18:06 +000048 <li><a href="#gc">Garbage Collector Names</a></li>
Chris Lattner4e9aba72006-01-23 23:23:47 +000049 <li><a href="#moduleasm">Module-Level Inline Assembly</a></li>
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +000050 <li><a href="#datalayout">Data Layout</a></li>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +000051 </ol>
52 </li>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +000053 <li><a href="#typesystem">Type System</a>
54 <ol>
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +000055 <li><a href="#t_classifications">Type Classifications</a></li>
Robert Bocchino7b81c752006-02-17 21:18:08 +000056 <li><a href="#t_primitive">Primitive Types</a>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +000057 <ol>
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +000058 <li><a href="#t_floating">Floating Point Types</a></li>
59 <li><a href="#t_void">Void Type</a></li>
60 <li><a href="#t_label">Label Type</a></li>
Nick Lewycky7a0370f2009-05-30 05:06:04 +000061 <li><a href="#t_metadata">Metadata Type</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +000062 </ol>
63 </li>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +000064 <li><a href="#t_derived">Derived Types</a>
65 <ol>
Chris Lattnerb9488a62007-12-18 06:18:21 +000066 <li><a href="#t_integer">Integer Type</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +000067 <li><a href="#t_array">Array Type</a></li>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +000068 <li><a href="#t_function">Function Type</a></li>
69 <li><a href="#t_pointer">Pointer Type</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +000070 <li><a href="#t_struct">Structure Type</a></li>
Andrew Lenharth75e10682006-12-08 17:13:00 +000071 <li><a href="#t_pstruct">Packed Structure Type</a></li>
Reid Spencer485bad12007-02-15 03:07:05 +000072 <li><a href="#t_vector">Vector Type</a></li>
Chris Lattner69c11bb2005-04-25 17:34:15 +000073 <li><a href="#t_opaque">Opaque Type</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +000074 </ol>
75 </li>
Chris Lattner242d61d2009-02-02 07:32:36 +000076 <li><a href="#t_uprefs">Type Up-references</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +000077 </ol>
78 </li>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +000079 <li><a href="#constants">Constants</a>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +000080 <ol>
Dan Gohman0e451ce2008-10-14 16:51:45 +000081 <li><a href="#simpleconstants">Simple Constants</a></li>
Chris Lattner70882792009-02-28 18:32:25 +000082 <li><a href="#complexconstants">Complex Constants</a></li>
Dan Gohman0e451ce2008-10-14 16:51:45 +000083 <li><a href="#globalconstants">Global Variable and Function Addresses</a></li>
84 <li><a href="#undefvalues">Undefined Values</a></li>
85 <li><a href="#constantexprs">Constant Expressions</a></li>
Nick Lewycky21cc4462009-04-04 07:22:01 +000086 <li><a href="#metadata">Embedded Metadata</a></li>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +000087 </ol>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +000088 </li>
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +000089 <li><a href="#othervalues">Other Values</a>
90 <ol>
Dan Gohman0e451ce2008-10-14 16:51:45 +000091 <li><a href="#inlineasm">Inline Assembler Expressions</a></li>
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +000092 </ol>
93 </li>
Chris Lattner857755c2009-07-20 05:55:19 +000094 <li><a href="#intrinsic_globals">Intrinsic Global Variables</a>
95 <ol>
96 <li><a href="#intg_used">The '<tt>llvm.used</tt>' Global Variable</a></li>
Chris Lattner401e10c2009-07-20 06:14:25 +000097 <li><a href="#intg_compiler_used">The '<tt>llvm.compiler.used</tt>'
98 Global Variable</a></li>
Chris Lattner857755c2009-07-20 05:55:19 +000099 <li><a href="#intg_global_ctors">The '<tt>llvm.global_ctors</tt>'
100 Global Variable</a></li>
101 <li><a href="#intg_global_dtors">The '<tt>llvm.global_dtors</tt>'
102 Global Variable</a></li>
103 </ol>
104 </li>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000105 <li><a href="#instref">Instruction Reference</a>
106 <ol>
107 <li><a href="#terminators">Terminator Instructions</a>
108 <ol>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000109 <li><a href="#i_ret">'<tt>ret</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
110 <li><a href="#i_br">'<tt>br</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000111 <li><a href="#i_switch">'<tt>switch</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
112 <li><a href="#i_invoke">'<tt>invoke</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000113 <li><a href="#i_unwind">'<tt>unwind</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +0000114 <li><a href="#i_unreachable">'<tt>unreachable</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000115 </ol>
116 </li>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000117 <li><a href="#binaryops">Binary Operations</a>
118 <ol>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000119 <li><a href="#i_add">'<tt>add</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000120 <li><a href="#i_fadd">'<tt>fadd</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000121 <li><a href="#i_sub">'<tt>sub</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000122 <li><a href="#i_fsub">'<tt>fsub</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000123 <li><a href="#i_mul">'<tt>mul</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000124 <li><a href="#i_fmul">'<tt>fmul</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000125 <li><a href="#i_udiv">'<tt>udiv</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
126 <li><a href="#i_sdiv">'<tt>sdiv</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
127 <li><a href="#i_fdiv">'<tt>fdiv</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000128 <li><a href="#i_urem">'<tt>urem</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
129 <li><a href="#i_srem">'<tt>srem</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
130 <li><a href="#i_frem">'<tt>frem</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000131 </ol>
132 </li>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000133 <li><a href="#bitwiseops">Bitwise Binary Operations</a>
134 <ol>
Reid Spencer8e11bf82007-02-02 13:57:07 +0000135 <li><a href="#i_shl">'<tt>shl</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
136 <li><a href="#i_lshr">'<tt>lshr</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
137 <li><a href="#i_ashr">'<tt>ashr</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000138 <li><a href="#i_and">'<tt>and</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000139 <li><a href="#i_or">'<tt>or</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000140 <li><a href="#i_xor">'<tt>xor</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000141 </ol>
142 </li>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +0000143 <li><a href="#vectorops">Vector Operations</a>
144 <ol>
145 <li><a href="#i_extractelement">'<tt>extractelement</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
146 <li><a href="#i_insertelement">'<tt>insertelement</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
147 <li><a href="#i_shufflevector">'<tt>shufflevector</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +0000148 </ol>
149 </li>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +0000150 <li><a href="#aggregateops">Aggregate Operations</a>
151 <ol>
152 <li><a href="#i_extractvalue">'<tt>extractvalue</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
153 <li><a href="#i_insertvalue">'<tt>insertvalue</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
154 </ol>
155 </li>
Chris Lattner884a9702006-08-15 00:45:58 +0000156 <li><a href="#memoryops">Memory Access and Addressing Operations</a>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000157 <ol>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000158 <li><a href="#i_malloc">'<tt>malloc</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
159 <li><a href="#i_free">'<tt>free</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
160 <li><a href="#i_alloca">'<tt>alloca</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Robert Bocchino7b81c752006-02-17 21:18:08 +0000161 <li><a href="#i_load">'<tt>load</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
162 <li><a href="#i_store">'<tt>store</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
163 <li><a href="#i_getelementptr">'<tt>getelementptr</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000164 </ol>
165 </li>
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +0000166 <li><a href="#convertops">Conversion Operations</a>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +0000167 <ol>
168 <li><a href="#i_trunc">'<tt>trunc .. to</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
169 <li><a href="#i_zext">'<tt>zext .. to</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
170 <li><a href="#i_sext">'<tt>sext .. to</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
171 <li><a href="#i_fptrunc">'<tt>fptrunc .. to</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
172 <li><a href="#i_fpext">'<tt>fpext .. to</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +0000173 <li><a href="#i_fptoui">'<tt>fptoui .. to</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
174 <li><a href="#i_fptosi">'<tt>fptosi .. to</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
175 <li><a href="#i_uitofp">'<tt>uitofp .. to</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
176 <li><a href="#i_sitofp">'<tt>sitofp .. to</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Reid Spencer72679252006-11-11 21:00:47 +0000177 <li><a href="#i_ptrtoint">'<tt>ptrtoint .. to</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
178 <li><a href="#i_inttoptr">'<tt>inttoptr .. to</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Reid Spencer5c0ef472006-11-11 23:08:07 +0000179 <li><a href="#i_bitcast">'<tt>bitcast .. to</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +0000180 </ol>
Dan Gohman0e451ce2008-10-14 16:51:45 +0000181 </li>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000182 <li><a href="#otherops">Other Operations</a>
183 <ol>
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +0000184 <li><a href="#i_icmp">'<tt>icmp</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
185 <li><a href="#i_fcmp">'<tt>fcmp</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000186 <li><a href="#i_phi">'<tt>phi</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +0000187 <li><a href="#i_select">'<tt>select</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000188 <li><a href="#i_call">'<tt>call</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattnerfb6977d2006-01-13 23:26:01 +0000189 <li><a href="#i_va_arg">'<tt>va_arg</tt>' Instruction</a></li>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000190 </ol>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000191 </li>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000192 </ol>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000193 </li>
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +0000194 <li><a href="#intrinsics">Intrinsic Functions</a>
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +0000195 <ol>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000196 <li><a href="#int_varargs">Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics</a>
197 <ol>
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +0000198 <li><a href="#int_va_start">'<tt>llvm.va_start</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
199 <li><a href="#int_va_end">'<tt>llvm.va_end</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
200 <li><a href="#int_va_copy">'<tt>llvm.va_copy</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000201 </ol>
202 </li>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000203 <li><a href="#int_gc">Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics</a>
204 <ol>
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +0000205 <li><a href="#int_gcroot">'<tt>llvm.gcroot</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
206 <li><a href="#int_gcread">'<tt>llvm.gcread</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
207 <li><a href="#int_gcwrite">'<tt>llvm.gcwrite</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000208 </ol>
209 </li>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +0000210 <li><a href="#int_codegen">Code Generator Intrinsics</a>
211 <ol>
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +0000212 <li><a href="#int_returnaddress">'<tt>llvm.returnaddress</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
213 <li><a href="#int_frameaddress">'<tt>llvm.frameaddress</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
214 <li><a href="#int_stacksave">'<tt>llvm.stacksave</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
215 <li><a href="#int_stackrestore">'<tt>llvm.stackrestore</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
216 <li><a href="#int_prefetch">'<tt>llvm.prefetch</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
217 <li><a href="#int_pcmarker">'<tt>llvm.pcmarker</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
218 <li><a href="#int_readcyclecounter"><tt>llvm.readcyclecounter</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
John Criswell7123e272004-04-09 16:43:20 +0000219 </ol>
220 </li>
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +0000221 <li><a href="#int_libc">Standard C Library Intrinsics</a>
222 <ol>
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +0000223 <li><a href="#int_memcpy">'<tt>llvm.memcpy.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
224 <li><a href="#int_memmove">'<tt>llvm.memmove.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
225 <li><a href="#int_memset">'<tt>llvm.memset.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
226 <li><a href="#int_sqrt">'<tt>llvm.sqrt.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
227 <li><a href="#int_powi">'<tt>llvm.powi.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +0000228 <li><a href="#int_sin">'<tt>llvm.sin.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
229 <li><a href="#int_cos">'<tt>llvm.cos.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
230 <li><a href="#int_pow">'<tt>llvm.pow.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +0000231 </ol>
232 </li>
Nate Begeman7e36c472006-01-13 23:26:38 +0000233 <li><a href="#int_manip">Bit Manipulation Intrinsics</a>
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +0000234 <ol>
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +0000235 <li><a href="#int_bswap">'<tt>llvm.bswap.*</tt>' Intrinsics</a></li>
Chris Lattner8a886be2006-01-16 22:34:14 +0000236 <li><a href="#int_ctpop">'<tt>llvm.ctpop.*</tt>' Intrinsic </a></li>
237 <li><a href="#int_ctlz">'<tt>llvm.ctlz.*</tt>' Intrinsic </a></li>
238 <li><a href="#int_cttz">'<tt>llvm.cttz.*</tt>' Intrinsic </a></li>
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +0000239 </ol>
240 </li>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +0000241 <li><a href="#int_overflow">Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics</a>
242 <ol>
Bill Wendlingda01af72009-02-08 04:04:40 +0000243 <li><a href="#int_sadd_overflow">'<tt>llvm.sadd.with.overflow.*</tt> Intrinsics</a></li>
244 <li><a href="#int_uadd_overflow">'<tt>llvm.uadd.with.overflow.*</tt> Intrinsics</a></li>
245 <li><a href="#int_ssub_overflow">'<tt>llvm.ssub.with.overflow.*</tt> Intrinsics</a></li>
246 <li><a href="#int_usub_overflow">'<tt>llvm.usub.with.overflow.*</tt> Intrinsics</a></li>
247 <li><a href="#int_smul_overflow">'<tt>llvm.smul.with.overflow.*</tt> Intrinsics</a></li>
Bill Wendling41b485c2009-02-08 23:00:09 +0000248 <li><a href="#int_umul_overflow">'<tt>llvm.umul.with.overflow.*</tt> Intrinsics</a></li>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +0000249 </ol>
250 </li>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000251 <li><a href="#int_debugger">Debugger intrinsics</a></li>
Jim Laskeydd4ef1b2007-03-14 19:31:19 +0000252 <li><a href="#int_eh">Exception Handling intrinsics</a></li>
Duncan Sandsf7331b32007-09-11 14:10:23 +0000253 <li><a href="#int_trampoline">Trampoline Intrinsic</a>
Duncan Sands36397f52007-07-27 12:58:54 +0000254 <ol>
255 <li><a href="#int_it">'<tt>llvm.init.trampoline</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
Duncan Sands36397f52007-07-27 12:58:54 +0000256 </ol>
257 </li>
Bill Wendling3c44f5b2008-11-18 22:10:53 +0000258 <li><a href="#int_atomics">Atomic intrinsics</a>
259 <ol>
260 <li><a href="#int_memory_barrier"><tt>llvm.memory_barrier</tt></a></li>
261 <li><a href="#int_atomic_cmp_swap"><tt>llvm.atomic.cmp.swap</tt></a></li>
262 <li><a href="#int_atomic_swap"><tt>llvm.atomic.swap</tt></a></li>
263 <li><a href="#int_atomic_load_add"><tt>llvm.atomic.load.add</tt></a></li>
264 <li><a href="#int_atomic_load_sub"><tt>llvm.atomic.load.sub</tt></a></li>
265 <li><a href="#int_atomic_load_and"><tt>llvm.atomic.load.and</tt></a></li>
266 <li><a href="#int_atomic_load_nand"><tt>llvm.atomic.load.nand</tt></a></li>
267 <li><a href="#int_atomic_load_or"><tt>llvm.atomic.load.or</tt></a></li>
268 <li><a href="#int_atomic_load_xor"><tt>llvm.atomic.load.xor</tt></a></li>
269 <li><a href="#int_atomic_load_max"><tt>llvm.atomic.load.max</tt></a></li>
270 <li><a href="#int_atomic_load_min"><tt>llvm.atomic.load.min</tt></a></li>
271 <li><a href="#int_atomic_load_umax"><tt>llvm.atomic.load.umax</tt></a></li>
272 <li><a href="#int_atomic_load_umin"><tt>llvm.atomic.load.umin</tt></a></li>
273 </ol>
274 </li>
Reid Spencer20677642007-07-20 19:59:11 +0000275 <li><a href="#int_general">General intrinsics</a>
Tanya Lattner6d806e92007-06-15 20:50:54 +0000276 <ol>
Reid Spencer20677642007-07-20 19:59:11 +0000277 <li><a href="#int_var_annotation">
Bill Wendling69e4adb2008-11-19 05:56:17 +0000278 '<tt>llvm.var.annotation</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
Tanya Lattnerb6367882007-09-21 22:59:12 +0000279 <li><a href="#int_annotation">
Bill Wendling69e4adb2008-11-19 05:56:17 +0000280 '<tt>llvm.annotation.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
Anton Korobeynikov4cb86182008-01-15 22:31:34 +0000281 <li><a href="#int_trap">
Bill Wendling69e4adb2008-11-19 05:56:17 +0000282 '<tt>llvm.trap</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
283 <li><a href="#int_stackprotector">
284 '<tt>llvm.stackprotector</tt>' Intrinsic</a></li>
Tanya Lattnerb6367882007-09-21 22:59:12 +0000285 </ol>
Tanya Lattner6d806e92007-06-15 20:50:54 +0000286 </li>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000287 </ol>
288 </li>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000289</ol>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000290
291<div class="doc_author">
292 <p>Written by <a href="mailto:sabre@nondot.org">Chris Lattner</a>
293 and <a href="mailto:vadve@cs.uiuc.edu">Vikram Adve</a></p>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000294</div>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000295
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000296<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000297<div class="doc_section"> <a name="abstract">Abstract </a></div>
298<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000299
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000300<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000301
302<p>This document is a reference manual for the LLVM assembly language. LLVM is
303 a Static Single Assignment (SSA) based representation that provides type
304 safety, low-level operations, flexibility, and the capability of representing
305 'all' high-level languages cleanly. It is the common code representation
306 used throughout all phases of the LLVM compilation strategy.</p>
307
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000308</div>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000309
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000310<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000311<div class="doc_section"> <a name="introduction">Introduction</a> </div>
312<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000313
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000314<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000315
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000316<p>The LLVM code representation is designed to be used in three different forms:
317 as an in-memory compiler IR, as an on-disk bitcode representation (suitable
318 for fast loading by a Just-In-Time compiler), and as a human readable
319 assembly language representation. This allows LLVM to provide a powerful
320 intermediate representation for efficient compiler transformations and
321 analysis, while providing a natural means to debug and visualize the
322 transformations. The three different forms of LLVM are all equivalent. This
323 document describes the human readable representation and notation.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000324
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000325<p>The LLVM representation aims to be light-weight and low-level while being
326 expressive, typed, and extensible at the same time. It aims to be a
327 "universal IR" of sorts, by being at a low enough level that high-level ideas
328 may be cleanly mapped to it (similar to how microprocessors are "universal
329 IR's", allowing many source languages to be mapped to them). By providing
330 type information, LLVM can be used as the target of optimizations: for
331 example, through pointer analysis, it can be proven that a C automatic
332 variable is never accessed outside of the current function... allowing it to
333 be promoted to a simple SSA value instead of a memory location.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000334
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000335</div>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000336
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000337<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000338<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="wellformed">Well-Formedness</a> </div>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000339
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000340<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000341
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000342<p>It is important to note that this document describes 'well formed' LLVM
343 assembly language. There is a difference between what the parser accepts and
344 what is considered 'well formed'. For example, the following instruction is
345 syntactically okay, but not well formed:</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000346
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000347<div class="doc_code">
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000348<pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000349%x = <a href="#i_add">add</a> i32 1, %x
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000350</pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000351</div>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000352
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000353<p>...because the definition of <tt>%x</tt> does not dominate all of its
354 uses. The LLVM infrastructure provides a verification pass that may be used
355 to verify that an LLVM module is well formed. This pass is automatically run
356 by the parser after parsing input assembly and by the optimizer before it
357 outputs bitcode. The violations pointed out by the verifier pass indicate
358 bugs in transformation passes or input to the parser.</p>
359
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000360</div>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000361
Chris Lattnercc689392007-10-03 17:34:29 +0000362<!-- Describe the typesetting conventions here. -->
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000363
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000364<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000365<div class="doc_section"> <a name="identifiers">Identifiers</a> </div>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000366<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000367
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000368<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000369
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000370<p>LLVM identifiers come in two basic types: global and local. Global
371 identifiers (functions, global variables) begin with the <tt>'@'</tt>
372 character. Local identifiers (register names, types) begin with
373 the <tt>'%'</tt> character. Additionally, there are three different formats
374 for identifiers, for different purposes:</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +0000375
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000376<ol>
Reid Spencer2c452282007-08-07 14:34:28 +0000377 <li>Named values are represented as a string of characters with their prefix.
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000378 For example, <tt>%foo</tt>, <tt>@DivisionByZero</tt>,
379 <tt>%a.really.long.identifier</tt>. The actual regular expression used is
380 '<tt>[%@][a-zA-Z$._][a-zA-Z$._0-9]*</tt>'. Identifiers which require
381 other characters in their names can be surrounded with quotes. Special
382 characters may be escaped using <tt>"\xx"</tt> where <tt>xx</tt> is the
383 ASCII code for the character in hexadecimal. In this way, any character
384 can be used in a name value, even quotes themselves.</li>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000385
Reid Spencer2c452282007-08-07 14:34:28 +0000386 <li>Unnamed values are represented as an unsigned numeric value with their
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000387 prefix. For example, <tt>%12</tt>, <tt>@2</tt>, <tt>%44</tt>.</li>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000388
Reid Spencercc16dc32004-12-09 18:02:53 +0000389 <li>Constants, which are described in a <a href="#constants">section about
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000390 constants</a>, below.</li>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000391</ol>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000392
Reid Spencer2c452282007-08-07 14:34:28 +0000393<p>LLVM requires that values start with a prefix for two reasons: Compilers
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000394 don't need to worry about name clashes with reserved words, and the set of
395 reserved words may be expanded in the future without penalty. Additionally,
396 unnamed identifiers allow a compiler to quickly come up with a temporary
397 variable without having to avoid symbol table conflicts.</p>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000398
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +0000399<p>Reserved words in LLVM are very similar to reserved words in other
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000400 languages. There are keywords for different opcodes
401 ('<tt><a href="#i_add">add</a></tt>',
402 '<tt><a href="#i_bitcast">bitcast</a></tt>',
403 '<tt><a href="#i_ret">ret</a></tt>', etc...), for primitive type names
404 ('<tt><a href="#t_void">void</a></tt>',
405 '<tt><a href="#t_primitive">i32</a></tt>', etc...), and others. These
406 reserved words cannot conflict with variable names, because none of them
407 start with a prefix character (<tt>'%'</tt> or <tt>'@'</tt>).</p>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000408
409<p>Here is an example of LLVM code to multiply the integer variable
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000410 '<tt>%X</tt>' by 8:</p>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000411
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000412<p>The easy way:</p>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000413
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000414<div class="doc_code">
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000415<pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000416%result = <a href="#i_mul">mul</a> i32 %X, 8
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000417</pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000418</div>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000419
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000420<p>After strength reduction:</p>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000421
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000422<div class="doc_code">
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000423<pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000424%result = <a href="#i_shl">shl</a> i32 %X, i8 3
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000425</pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000426</div>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000427
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000428<p>And the hard way:</p>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000429
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000430<div class="doc_code">
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000431<pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000432<a href="#i_add">add</a> i32 %X, %X <i>; yields {i32}:%0</i>
433<a href="#i_add">add</a> i32 %0, %0 <i>; yields {i32}:%1</i>
434%result = <a href="#i_add">add</a> i32 %1, %1
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000435</pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000436</div>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000437
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000438<p>This last way of multiplying <tt>%X</tt> by 8 illustrates several important
439 lexical features of LLVM:</p>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000440
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +0000441<ol>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000442 <li>Comments are delimited with a '<tt>;</tt>' and go until the end of
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000443 line.</li>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000444
445 <li>Unnamed temporaries are created when the result of a computation is not
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000446 assigned to a named value.</li>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000447
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000448 <li>Unnamed temporaries are numbered sequentially</li>
449</ol>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000450
John Criswelle4c57cc2005-05-12 16:52:32 +0000451<p>...and it also shows a convention that we follow in this document. When
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000452 demonstrating instructions, we will follow an instruction with a comment that
453 defines the type and name of value produced. Comments are shown in italic
454 text.</p>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000455
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +0000456</div>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000457
458<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
459<div class="doc_section"> <a name="highlevel">High Level Structure</a> </div>
460<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
461
462<!-- ======================================================================= -->
463<div class="doc_subsection"> <a name="modulestructure">Module Structure</a>
464</div>
465
466<div class="doc_text">
467
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000468<p>LLVM programs are composed of "Module"s, each of which is a translation unit
469 of the input programs. Each module consists of functions, global variables,
470 and symbol table entries. Modules may be combined together with the LLVM
471 linker, which merges function (and global variable) definitions, resolves
472 forward declarations, and merges symbol table entries. Here is an example of
473 the "hello world" module:</p>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000474
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000475<div class="doc_code">
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000476<pre><i>; Declare the string constant as a global constant...</i>
Chris Lattnera89e5f12007-06-12 17:00:26 +0000477<a href="#identifiers">@.LC0</a> = <a href="#linkage_internal">internal</a> <a
478 href="#globalvars">constant</a> <a href="#t_array">[13 x i8]</a> c"hello world\0A\00" <i>; [13 x i8]*</i>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000479
480<i>; External declaration of the puts function</i>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000481<a href="#functionstructure">declare</a> i32 @puts(i8 *) <i>; i32(i8 *)* </i>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000482
483<i>; Definition of main function</i>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000484define i32 @main() { <i>; i32()* </i>
Dan Gohman2a08c532009-01-04 23:44:43 +0000485 <i>; Convert [13 x i8]* to i8 *...</i>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000486 %cast210 = <a
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000487 href="#i_getelementptr">getelementptr</a> [13 x i8]* @.LC0, i64 0, i64 0 <i>; i8 *</i>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000488
489 <i>; Call puts function to write out the string to stdout...</i>
490 <a
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000491 href="#i_call">call</a> i32 @puts(i8 * %cast210) <i>; i32</i>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000492 <a
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000493 href="#i_ret">ret</a> i32 0<br>}<br>
494</pre>
495</div>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000496
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000497<p>This example is made up of a <a href="#globalvars">global variable</a> named
498 "<tt>.LC0</tt>", an external declaration of the "<tt>puts</tt>" function, and
499 a <a href="#functionstructure">function definition</a> for
500 "<tt>main</tt>".</p>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000501
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000502<p>In general, a module is made up of a list of global values, where both
503 functions and global variables are global values. Global values are
504 represented by a pointer to a memory location (in this case, a pointer to an
505 array of char, and a pointer to a function), and have one of the
506 following <a href="#linkage">linkage types</a>.</p>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000507
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000508</div>
509
510<!-- ======================================================================= -->
511<div class="doc_subsection">
512 <a name="linkage">Linkage Types</a>
513</div>
514
515<div class="doc_text">
516
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000517<p>All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following types of
518 linkage:</p>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000519
520<dl>
Rafael Espindolabb46f522009-01-15 20:18:42 +0000521 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_private">private</a></b></tt>: </dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000522 <dd>Global values with private linkage are only directly accessible by objects
523 in the current module. In particular, linking code into a module with an
524 private global value may cause the private to be renamed as necessary to
525 avoid collisions. Because the symbol is private to the module, all
526 references can be updated. This doesn't show up in any symbol table in the
527 object file.</dd>
Rafael Espindolabb46f522009-01-15 20:18:42 +0000528
Bill Wendling3d10a5a2009-07-20 01:03:30 +0000529 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_linker_private">linker_private</a></b></tt>: </dt>
Bill Wendling3d10a5a2009-07-20 01:03:30 +0000530 <dd>Similar to private, but the symbol is passed through the assembler and
531 removed by the linker after evaluation.</dd>
532
Dale Johannesen2307a7f2008-05-23 23:13:41 +0000533 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_internal">internal</a></b></tt>: </dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000534 <dd>Similar to private, but the value shows as a local symbol
535 (<tt>STB_LOCAL</tt> in the case of ELF) in the object file. This
536 corresponds to the notion of the '<tt>static</tt>' keyword in C.</dd>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000537
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000538 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_available_externally">available_externally</a></b></tt>: </dt>
Chris Lattner266c7bb2009-04-13 05:44:34 +0000539 <dd>Globals with "<tt>available_externally</tt>" linkage are never emitted
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000540 into the object file corresponding to the LLVM module. They exist to
541 allow inlining and other optimizations to take place given knowledge of
542 the definition of the global, which is known to be somewhere outside the
543 module. Globals with <tt>available_externally</tt> linkage are allowed to
544 be discarded at will, and are otherwise the same as <tt>linkonce_odr</tt>.
545 This linkage type is only allowed on definitions, not declarations.</dd>
Chris Lattner266c7bb2009-04-13 05:44:34 +0000546
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000547 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_linkonce">linkonce</a></b></tt>: </dt>
Chris Lattner4887bd82007-01-14 06:51:48 +0000548 <dd>Globals with "<tt>linkonce</tt>" linkage are merged with other globals of
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000549 the same name when linkage occurs. This is typically used to implement
550 inline functions, templates, or other code which must be generated in each
551 translation unit that uses it. Unreferenced <tt>linkonce</tt> globals are
552 allowed to be discarded.</dd>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000553
Dale Johannesen2307a7f2008-05-23 23:13:41 +0000554 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_common">common</a></b></tt>: </dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000555 <dd>"<tt>common</tt>" linkage is exactly the same as <tt>linkonce</tt>
556 linkage, except that unreferenced <tt>common</tt> globals may not be
557 discarded. This is used for globals that may be emitted in multiple
558 translation units, but that are not guaranteed to be emitted into every
559 translation unit that uses them. One example of this is tentative
560 definitions in C, such as "<tt>int X;</tt>" at global scope.</dd>
Dale Johannesen2307a7f2008-05-23 23:13:41 +0000561
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000562 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_weak">weak</a></b></tt>: </dt>
Dale Johannesen2307a7f2008-05-23 23:13:41 +0000563 <dd>"<tt>weak</tt>" linkage is the same as <tt>common</tt> linkage, except
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000564 that some targets may choose to emit different assembly sequences for them
565 for target-dependent reasons. This is used for globals that are declared
566 "weak" in C source code.</dd>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000567
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000568 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_appending">appending</a></b></tt>: </dt>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000569 <dd>"<tt>appending</tt>" linkage may only be applied to global variables of
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000570 pointer to array type. When two global variables with appending linkage
571 are linked together, the two global arrays are appended together. This is
572 the LLVM, typesafe, equivalent of having the system linker append together
573 "sections" with identical names when .o files are linked.</dd>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000574
Anton Korobeynikov7f705592007-01-12 19:20:47 +0000575 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_externweak">extern_weak</a></b></tt>: </dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000576 <dd>The semantics of this linkage follow the ELF object file model: the symbol
577 is weak until linked, if not linked, the symbol becomes null instead of
578 being an undefined reference.</dd>
Anton Korobeynikov7f705592007-01-12 19:20:47 +0000579
Duncan Sands667d4b82009-03-07 15:45:40 +0000580 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_linkonce">linkonce_odr</a></b></tt>: </dt>
Duncan Sands667d4b82009-03-07 15:45:40 +0000581 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_weak">weak_odr</a></b></tt>: </dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000582 <dd>Some languages allow differing globals to be merged, such as two functions
583 with different semantics. Other languages, such as <tt>C++</tt>, ensure
584 that only equivalent globals are ever merged (the "one definition rule" -
585 "ODR"). Such languages can use the <tt>linkonce_odr</tt>
586 and <tt>weak_odr</tt> linkage types to indicate that the global will only
587 be merged with equivalent globals. These linkage types are otherwise the
588 same as their non-<tt>odr</tt> versions.</dd>
Duncan Sands667d4b82009-03-07 15:45:40 +0000589
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000590 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_external">externally visible</a></b></tt>:</dt>
Chris Lattnere5d947b2004-12-09 16:36:40 +0000591 <dd>If none of the above identifiers are used, the global is externally
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000592 visible, meaning that it participates in linkage and can be used to
593 resolve external symbol references.</dd>
Reid Spencerc8910842007-04-11 23:49:50 +0000594</dl>
Anton Korobeynikovb74ed072006-09-14 18:23:27 +0000595
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000596<p>The next two types of linkage are targeted for Microsoft Windows platform
597 only. They are designed to support importing (exporting) symbols from (to)
598 DLLs (Dynamic Link Libraries).</p>
Anton Korobeynikovb74ed072006-09-14 18:23:27 +0000599
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000600<dl>
Anton Korobeynikovb74ed072006-09-14 18:23:27 +0000601 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_dllimport">dllimport</a></b></tt>: </dt>
Anton Korobeynikovb74ed072006-09-14 18:23:27 +0000602 <dd>"<tt>dllimport</tt>" linkage causes the compiler to reference a function
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000603 or variable via a global pointer to a pointer that is set up by the DLL
604 exporting the symbol. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is
605 formed by combining <code>__imp_</code> and the function or variable
606 name.</dd>
Anton Korobeynikovb74ed072006-09-14 18:23:27 +0000607
608 <dt><tt><b><a name="linkage_dllexport">dllexport</a></b></tt>: </dt>
Anton Korobeynikovb74ed072006-09-14 18:23:27 +0000609 <dd>"<tt>dllexport</tt>" linkage causes the compiler to provide a global
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000610 pointer to a pointer in a DLL, so that it can be referenced with the
611 <tt>dllimport</tt> attribute. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer
612 name is formed by combining <code>__imp_</code> and the function or
613 variable name.</dd>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000614</dl>
615
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000616<p>For example, since the "<tt>.LC0</tt>" variable is defined to be internal, if
617 another module defined a "<tt>.LC0</tt>" variable and was linked with this
618 one, one of the two would be renamed, preventing a collision. Since
619 "<tt>main</tt>" and "<tt>puts</tt>" are external (i.e., lacking any linkage
620 declarations), they are accessible outside of the current module.</p>
621
622<p>It is illegal for a function <i>declaration</i> to have any linkage type
623 other than "externally visible", <tt>dllimport</tt>
624 or <tt>extern_weak</tt>.</p>
625
Duncan Sands667d4b82009-03-07 15:45:40 +0000626<p>Aliases can have only <tt>external</tt>, <tt>internal</tt>, <tt>weak</tt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000627 or <tt>weak_odr</tt> linkages.</p>
628
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000629</div>
630
631<!-- ======================================================================= -->
632<div class="doc_subsection">
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +0000633 <a name="callingconv">Calling Conventions</a>
634</div>
635
636<div class="doc_text">
637
638<p>LLVM <a href="#functionstructure">functions</a>, <a href="#i_call">calls</a>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000639 and <a href="#i_invoke">invokes</a> can all have an optional calling
640 convention specified for the call. The calling convention of any pair of
641 dynamic caller/callee must match, or the behavior of the program is
642 undefined. The following calling conventions are supported by LLVM, and more
643 may be added in the future:</p>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +0000644
645<dl>
646 <dt><b>"<tt>ccc</tt>" - The C calling convention</b>:</dt>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +0000647 <dd>This calling convention (the default if no other calling convention is
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000648 specified) matches the target C calling conventions. This calling
649 convention supports varargs function calls and tolerates some mismatch in
650 the declared prototype and implemented declaration of the function (as
651 does normal C).</dd>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +0000652
653 <dt><b>"<tt>fastcc</tt>" - The fast calling convention</b>:</dt>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +0000654 <dd>This calling convention attempts to make calls as fast as possible
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000655 (e.g. by passing things in registers). This calling convention allows the
656 target to use whatever tricks it wants to produce fast code for the
657 target, without having to conform to an externally specified ABI
658 (Application Binary Interface). Implementations of this convention should
659 allow arbitrary <a href="CodeGenerator.html#tailcallopt">tail call
660 optimization</a> to be supported. This calling convention does not
661 support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to exactly match
662 the prototype of the function definition.</dd>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +0000663
664 <dt><b>"<tt>coldcc</tt>" - The cold calling convention</b>:</dt>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +0000665 <dd>This calling convention attempts to make code in the caller as efficient
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000666 as possible under the assumption that the call is not commonly executed.
667 As such, these calls often preserve all registers so that the call does
668 not break any live ranges in the caller side. This calling convention
669 does not support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to
670 exactly match the prototype of the function definition.</dd>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +0000671
Chris Lattnercfe6b372005-05-07 01:46:40 +0000672 <dt><b>"<tt>cc &lt;<em>n</em>&gt;</tt>" - Numbered convention</b>:</dt>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +0000673 <dd>Any calling convention may be specified by number, allowing
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000674 target-specific calling conventions to be used. Target specific calling
675 conventions start at 64.</dd>
Chris Lattnercfe6b372005-05-07 01:46:40 +0000676</dl>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +0000677
678<p>More calling conventions can be added/defined on an as-needed basis, to
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000679 support Pascal conventions or any other well-known target-independent
680 convention.</p>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +0000681
682</div>
683
684<!-- ======================================================================= -->
685<div class="doc_subsection">
Anton Korobeynikov8cea37b2007-01-23 12:35:46 +0000686 <a name="visibility">Visibility Styles</a>
687</div>
688
689<div class="doc_text">
690
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000691<p>All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following visibility
692 styles:</p>
Anton Korobeynikov8cea37b2007-01-23 12:35:46 +0000693
694<dl>
695 <dt><b>"<tt>default</tt>" - Default style</b>:</dt>
Chris Lattnerd3eda892008-08-05 18:29:16 +0000696 <dd>On targets that use the ELF object file format, default visibility means
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000697 that the declaration is visible to other modules and, in shared libraries,
698 means that the declared entity may be overridden. On Darwin, default
699 visibility means that the declaration is visible to other modules. Default
700 visibility corresponds to "external linkage" in the language.</dd>
Anton Korobeynikov8cea37b2007-01-23 12:35:46 +0000701
702 <dt><b>"<tt>hidden</tt>" - Hidden style</b>:</dt>
Anton Korobeynikov8cea37b2007-01-23 12:35:46 +0000703 <dd>Two declarations of an object with hidden visibility refer to the same
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000704 object if they are in the same shared object. Usually, hidden visibility
705 indicates that the symbol will not be placed into the dynamic symbol
706 table, so no other module (executable or shared library) can reference it
707 directly.</dd>
Anton Korobeynikov8cea37b2007-01-23 12:35:46 +0000708
Anton Korobeynikov6f9896f2007-04-29 18:35:00 +0000709 <dt><b>"<tt>protected</tt>" - Protected style</b>:</dt>
Anton Korobeynikov6f9896f2007-04-29 18:35:00 +0000710 <dd>On ELF, protected visibility indicates that the symbol will be placed in
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000711 the dynamic symbol table, but that references within the defining module
712 will bind to the local symbol. That is, the symbol cannot be overridden by
713 another module.</dd>
Anton Korobeynikov8cea37b2007-01-23 12:35:46 +0000714</dl>
715
716</div>
717
718<!-- ======================================================================= -->
719<div class="doc_subsection">
Chris Lattnere7886e42009-01-11 20:53:49 +0000720 <a name="namedtypes">Named Types</a>
721</div>
722
723<div class="doc_text">
724
725<p>LLVM IR allows you to specify name aliases for certain types. This can make
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000726 it easier to read the IR and make the IR more condensed (particularly when
727 recursive types are involved). An example of a name specification is:</p>
Chris Lattnere7886e42009-01-11 20:53:49 +0000728
729<div class="doc_code">
730<pre>
731%mytype = type { %mytype*, i32 }
732</pre>
733</div>
734
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000735<p>You may give a name to any <a href="#typesystem">type</a> except
736 "<a href="t_void">void</a>". Type name aliases may be used anywhere a type
737 is expected with the syntax "%mytype".</p>
Chris Lattnere7886e42009-01-11 20:53:49 +0000738
739<p>Note that type names are aliases for the structural type that they indicate,
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000740 and that you can therefore specify multiple names for the same type. This
741 often leads to confusing behavior when dumping out a .ll file. Since LLVM IR
742 uses structural typing, the name is not part of the type. When printing out
743 LLVM IR, the printer will pick <em>one name</em> to render all types of a
744 particular shape. This means that if you have code where two different
745 source types end up having the same LLVM type, that the dumper will sometimes
746 print the "wrong" or unexpected type. This is an important design point and
747 isn't going to change.</p>
Chris Lattnere7886e42009-01-11 20:53:49 +0000748
749</div>
750
Chris Lattnere7886e42009-01-11 20:53:49 +0000751<!-- ======================================================================= -->
752<div class="doc_subsection">
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000753 <a name="globalvars">Global Variables</a>
754</div>
755
756<div class="doc_text">
757
Chris Lattner3689a342005-02-12 19:30:21 +0000758<p>Global variables define regions of memory allocated at compilation time
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000759 instead of run-time. Global variables may optionally be initialized, may
760 have an explicit section to be placed in, and may have an optional explicit
761 alignment specified. A variable may be defined as "thread_local", which
762 means that it will not be shared by threads (each thread will have a
763 separated copy of the variable). A variable may be defined as a global
764 "constant," which indicates that the contents of the variable
765 will <b>never</b> be modified (enabling better optimization, allowing the
766 global data to be placed in the read-only section of an executable, etc).
767 Note that variables that need runtime initialization cannot be marked
768 "constant" as there is a store to the variable.</p>
Chris Lattner3689a342005-02-12 19:30:21 +0000769
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000770<p>LLVM explicitly allows <em>declarations</em> of global variables to be marked
771 constant, even if the final definition of the global is not. This capability
772 can be used to enable slightly better optimization of the program, but
773 requires the language definition to guarantee that optimizations based on the
774 'constantness' are valid for the translation units that do not include the
775 definition.</p>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000776
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000777<p>As SSA values, global variables define pointer values that are in scope
778 (i.e. they dominate) all basic blocks in the program. Global variables
779 always define a pointer to their "content" type because they describe a
780 region of memory, and all memory objects in LLVM are accessed through
781 pointers.</p>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000782
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000783<p>A global variable may be declared to reside in a target-specific numbered
784 address space. For targets that support them, address spaces may affect how
785 optimizations are performed and/or what target instructions are used to
786 access the variable. The default address space is zero. The address space
787 qualifier must precede any other attributes.</p>
Christopher Lamb284d9922007-12-11 09:31:00 +0000788
Chris Lattner88f6c462005-11-12 00:45:07 +0000789<p>LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for globals. If the target
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000790 supports it, it will emit globals to the section specified.</p>
Chris Lattner88f6c462005-11-12 00:45:07 +0000791
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +0000792<p>An explicit alignment may be specified for a global. If not present, or if
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000793 the alignment is set to zero, the alignment of the global is set by the
794 target to whatever it feels convenient. If an explicit alignment is
795 specified, the global is forced to have at least that much alignment. All
796 alignments must be a power of 2.</p>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +0000797
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000798<p>For example, the following defines a global in a numbered address space with
799 an initializer, section, and alignment:</p>
Chris Lattner68027ea2007-01-14 00:27:09 +0000800
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000801<div class="doc_code">
Chris Lattner68027ea2007-01-14 00:27:09 +0000802<pre>
Dan Gohman398873c2009-01-11 00:40:00 +0000803@G = addrspace(5) constant float 1.0, section "foo", align 4
Chris Lattner68027ea2007-01-14 00:27:09 +0000804</pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000805</div>
Chris Lattner68027ea2007-01-14 00:27:09 +0000806
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000807</div>
808
809
810<!-- ======================================================================= -->
811<div class="doc_subsection">
812 <a name="functionstructure">Functions</a>
813</div>
814
815<div class="doc_text">
816
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000817<p>LLVM function definitions consist of the "<tt>define</tt>" keyord, an
818 optional <a href="#linkage">linkage type</a>, an optional
819 <a href="#visibility">visibility style</a>, an optional
820 <a href="#callingconv">calling convention</a>, a return type, an optional
821 <a href="#paramattrs">parameter attribute</a> for the return type, a function
822 name, a (possibly empty) argument list (each with optional
823 <a href="#paramattrs">parameter attributes</a>), optional
824 <a href="#fnattrs">function attributes</a>, an optional section, an optional
825 alignment, an optional <a href="#gc">garbage collector name</a>, an opening
826 curly brace, a list of basic blocks, and a closing curly brace.</p>
Anton Korobeynikov8cea37b2007-01-23 12:35:46 +0000827
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000828<p>LLVM function declarations consist of the "<tt>declare</tt>" keyword, an
829 optional <a href="#linkage">linkage type</a>, an optional
830 <a href="#visibility">visibility style</a>, an optional
831 <a href="#callingconv">calling convention</a>, a return type, an optional
832 <a href="#paramattrs">parameter attribute</a> for the return type, a function
833 name, a possibly empty list of arguments, an optional alignment, and an
834 optional <a href="#gc">garbage collector name</a>.</p>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000835
Chris Lattnerd3eda892008-08-05 18:29:16 +0000836<p>A function definition contains a list of basic blocks, forming the CFG
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000837 (Control Flow Graph) for the function. Each basic block may optionally start
838 with a label (giving the basic block a symbol table entry), contains a list
839 of instructions, and ends with a <a href="#terminators">terminator</a>
840 instruction (such as a branch or function return).</p>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000841
Chris Lattner4a3c9012007-06-08 16:52:14 +0000842<p>The first basic block in a function is special in two ways: it is immediately
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000843 executed on entrance to the function, and it is not allowed to have
844 predecessor basic blocks (i.e. there can not be any branches to the entry
845 block of a function). Because the block can have no predecessors, it also
846 cannot have any <a href="#i_phi">PHI nodes</a>.</p>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000847
Chris Lattner88f6c462005-11-12 00:45:07 +0000848<p>LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for functions. If the target
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000849 supports it, it will emit functions to the section specified.</p>
Chris Lattner88f6c462005-11-12 00:45:07 +0000850
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +0000851<p>An explicit alignment may be specified for a function. If not present, or if
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000852 the alignment is set to zero, the alignment of the function is set by the
853 target to whatever it feels convenient. If an explicit alignment is
854 specified, the function is forced to have at least that much alignment. All
855 alignments must be a power of 2.</p>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +0000856
Bill Wendlingc39e3e02009-07-20 02:39:26 +0000857<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Devang Patel307e8ab2008-10-07 17:48:33 +0000858<div class="doc_code">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000859<pre>
Chris Lattner50ad45c2008-10-13 16:55:18 +0000860define [<a href="#linkage">linkage</a>] [<a href="#visibility">visibility</a>]
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000861 [<a href="#callingconv">cconv</a>] [<a href="#paramattrs">ret attrs</a>]
862 &lt;ResultType&gt; @&lt;FunctionName&gt; ([argument list])
863 [<a href="#fnattrs">fn Attrs</a>] [section "name"] [align N]
864 [<a href="#gc">gc</a>] { ... }
865</pre>
Devang Patel307e8ab2008-10-07 17:48:33 +0000866</div>
867
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +0000868</div>
869
Anton Korobeynikov8b0a8c82007-04-25 14:27:10 +0000870<!-- ======================================================================= -->
871<div class="doc_subsection">
872 <a name="aliasstructure">Aliases</a>
873</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000874
Anton Korobeynikov8b0a8c82007-04-25 14:27:10 +0000875<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000876
877<p>Aliases act as "second name" for the aliasee value (which can be either
878 function, global variable, another alias or bitcast of global value). Aliases
879 may have an optional <a href="#linkage">linkage type</a>, and an
880 optional <a href="#visibility">visibility style</a>.</p>
Anton Korobeynikov8b0a8c82007-04-25 14:27:10 +0000881
Bill Wendlingc39e3e02009-07-20 02:39:26 +0000882<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000883<div class="doc_code">
Bill Wendlingaac388b2007-05-29 09:42:13 +0000884<pre>
Duncan Sands0b23ac12008-09-12 20:48:21 +0000885@&lt;Name&gt; = alias [Linkage] [Visibility] &lt;AliaseeTy&gt; @&lt;Aliasee&gt;
Bill Wendlingaac388b2007-05-29 09:42:13 +0000886</pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000887</div>
Anton Korobeynikov8b0a8c82007-04-25 14:27:10 +0000888
889</div>
890
Chris Lattner4e9aba72006-01-23 23:23:47 +0000891<!-- ======================================================================= -->
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +0000892<div class="doc_subsection"><a name="paramattrs">Parameter Attributes</a></div>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +0000893
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000894<div class="doc_text">
895
896<p>The return type and each parameter of a function type may have a set of
897 <i>parameter attributes</i> associated with them. Parameter attributes are
898 used to communicate additional information about the result or parameters of
899 a function. Parameter attributes are considered to be part of the function,
900 not of the function type, so functions with different parameter attributes
901 can have the same function type.</p>
902
903<p>Parameter attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified. If
904 multiple parameter attributes are needed, they are space separated. For
905 example:</p>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000906
907<div class="doc_code">
908<pre>
Nick Lewyckyb6a7d252009-02-15 23:06:14 +0000909declare i32 @printf(i8* noalias nocapture, ...)
Chris Lattner66d922c2008-10-04 18:33:34 +0000910declare i32 @atoi(i8 zeroext)
911declare signext i8 @returns_signed_char()
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +0000912</pre>
913</div>
914
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000915<p>Note that any attributes for the function result (<tt>nounwind</tt>,
916 <tt>readonly</tt>) come immediately after the argument list.</p>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +0000917
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000918<p>Currently, only the following parameter attributes are defined:</p>
Chris Lattner47507de2008-01-11 06:20:47 +0000919
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000920<dl>
921 <dt><tt>zeroext</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000922 <dd>This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return value
923 should be zero-extended to a 32-bit value by the caller (for a parameter)
924 or the callee (for a return value).</dd>
Chris Lattner47507de2008-01-11 06:20:47 +0000925
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000926 <dt><tt>signext</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000927 <dd>This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return value
928 should be sign-extended to a 32-bit value by the caller (for a parameter)
929 or the callee (for a return value).</dd>
Chris Lattner47507de2008-01-11 06:20:47 +0000930
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000931 <dt><tt>inreg</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000932 <dd>This indicates that this parameter or return value should be treated in a
933 special target-dependent fashion during while emitting code for a function
934 call or return (usually, by putting it in a register as opposed to memory,
935 though some targets use it to distinguish between two different kinds of
936 registers). Use of this attribute is target-specific.</dd>
Chris Lattner47507de2008-01-11 06:20:47 +0000937
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000938 <dt><tt><a name="byval">byval</a></tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000939 <dd>This indicates that the pointer parameter should really be passed by value
940 to the function. The attribute implies that a hidden copy of the pointee
941 is made between the caller and the callee, so the callee is unable to
942 modify the value in the callee. This attribute is only valid on LLVM
943 pointer arguments. It is generally used to pass structs and arrays by
944 value, but is also valid on pointers to scalars. The copy is considered
945 to belong to the caller not the callee (for example,
946 <tt><a href="#readonly">readonly</a></tt> functions should not write to
947 <tt>byval</tt> parameters). This is not a valid attribute for return
948 values. The byval attribute also supports specifying an alignment with
949 the align attribute. This has a target-specific effect on the code
950 generator that usually indicates a desired alignment for the synthesized
951 stack slot.</dd>
952
953 <dt><tt>sret</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000954 <dd>This indicates that the pointer parameter specifies the address of a
955 structure that is the return value of the function in the source program.
956 This pointer must be guaranteed by the caller to be valid: loads and
957 stores to the structure may be assumed by the callee to not to trap. This
958 may only be applied to the first parameter. This is not a valid attribute
959 for return values. </dd>
960
961 <dt><tt>noalias</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000962 <dd>This indicates that the pointer does not alias any global or any other
963 parameter. The caller is responsible for ensuring that this is the
964 case. On a function return value, <tt>noalias</tt> additionally indicates
965 that the pointer does not alias any other pointers visible to the
966 caller. For further details, please see the discussion of the NoAlias
967 response in
968 <a href="http://llvm.org/docs/AliasAnalysis.html#MustMayNo">alias
969 analysis</a>.</dd>
970
971 <dt><tt>nocapture</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000972 <dd>This indicates that the callee does not make any copies of the pointer
973 that outlive the callee itself. This is not a valid attribute for return
974 values.</dd>
975
976 <dt><tt>nest</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000977 <dd>This indicates that the pointer parameter can be excised using the
978 <a href="#int_trampoline">trampoline intrinsics</a>. This is not a valid
979 attribute for return values.</dd>
980</dl>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +0000981
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +0000982</div>
983
984<!-- ======================================================================= -->
Chris Lattner4e9aba72006-01-23 23:23:47 +0000985<div class="doc_subsection">
Gordon Henriksen80a75bf2007-12-10 03:18:06 +0000986 <a name="gc">Garbage Collector Names</a>
987</div>
988
989<div class="doc_text">
Gordon Henriksen80a75bf2007-12-10 03:18:06 +0000990
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +0000991<p>Each function may specify a garbage collector name, which is simply a
992 string:</p>
993
994<div class="doc_code">
995<pre>
996define void @f() gc "name" { ...
997</pre>
998</div>
Gordon Henriksen80a75bf2007-12-10 03:18:06 +0000999
1000<p>The compiler declares the supported values of <i>name</i>. Specifying a
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001001 collector which will cause the compiler to alter its output in order to
1002 support the named garbage collection algorithm.</p>
1003
Gordon Henriksen80a75bf2007-12-10 03:18:06 +00001004</div>
1005
1006<!-- ======================================================================= -->
1007<div class="doc_subsection">
Devang Patel2c9c3e72008-09-26 23:51:19 +00001008 <a name="fnattrs">Function Attributes</a>
Devang Patelf8b94812008-09-04 23:05:13 +00001009</div>
1010
1011<div class="doc_text">
Devang Patel2c9c3e72008-09-26 23:51:19 +00001012
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001013<p>Function attributes are set to communicate additional information about a
1014 function. Function attributes are considered to be part of the function, not
1015 of the function type, so functions with different parameter attributes can
1016 have the same function type.</p>
Devang Patel2c9c3e72008-09-26 23:51:19 +00001017
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001018<p>Function attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified. If
1019 multiple attributes are needed, they are space separated. For example:</p>
Devang Patelf8b94812008-09-04 23:05:13 +00001020
1021<div class="doc_code">
Bill Wendlinge36dccc2008-09-07 10:26:33 +00001022<pre>
Devang Patel2c9c3e72008-09-26 23:51:19 +00001023define void @f() noinline { ... }
1024define void @f() alwaysinline { ... }
1025define void @f() alwaysinline optsize { ... }
1026define void @f() optsize
Bill Wendlinge36dccc2008-09-07 10:26:33 +00001027</pre>
Devang Patelf8b94812008-09-04 23:05:13 +00001028</div>
1029
Bill Wendlinge36dccc2008-09-07 10:26:33 +00001030<dl>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001031 <dt><tt>alwaysinline</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001032 <dd>This attribute indicates that the inliner should attempt to inline this
1033 function into callers whenever possible, ignoring any active inlining size
1034 threshold for this caller.</dd>
Bill Wendlinge36dccc2008-09-07 10:26:33 +00001035
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001036 <dt><tt>noinline</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001037 <dd>This attribute indicates that the inliner should never inline this
1038 function in any situation. This attribute may not be used together with
1039 the <tt>alwaysinline</tt> attribute.</dd>
Devang Patel2c9c3e72008-09-26 23:51:19 +00001040
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001041 <dt><tt>optsize</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001042 <dd>This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator passes
1043 make choices that keep the code size of this function low, and otherwise
1044 do optimizations specifically to reduce code size.</dd>
Devang Patel2c9c3e72008-09-26 23:51:19 +00001045
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001046 <dt><tt>noreturn</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001047 <dd>This function attribute indicates that the function never returns
1048 normally. This produces undefined behavior at runtime if the function
1049 ever does dynamically return.</dd>
Bill Wendling31359ba2008-11-13 01:02:51 +00001050
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001051 <dt><tt>nounwind</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001052 <dd>This function attribute indicates that the function never returns with an
1053 unwind or exceptional control flow. If the function does unwind, its
1054 runtime behavior is undefined.</dd>
Bill Wendlingfbaa7ed2008-11-26 19:07:40 +00001055
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001056 <dt><tt>readnone</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001057 <dd>This attribute indicates that the function computes its result (or decides
1058 to unwind an exception) based strictly on its arguments, without
1059 dereferencing any pointer arguments or otherwise accessing any mutable
1060 state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to caller functions.
1061 It does not write through any pointer arguments
1062 (including <tt><a href="#byval">byval</a></tt> arguments) and never
1063 changes any state visible to callers. This means that it cannot unwind
1064 exceptions by calling the <tt>C++</tt> exception throwing methods, but
1065 could use the <tt>unwind</tt> instruction.</dd>
Devang Patel5d96fda2009-06-12 19:45:19 +00001066
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001067 <dt><tt><a name="readonly">readonly</a></tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001068 <dd>This attribute indicates that the function does not write through any
1069 pointer arguments (including <tt><a href="#byval">byval</a></tt>
1070 arguments) or otherwise modify any state (e.g. memory, control registers,
1071 etc) visible to caller functions. It may dereference pointer arguments
1072 and read state that may be set in the caller. A readonly function always
1073 returns the same value (or unwinds an exception identically) when called
1074 with the same set of arguments and global state. It cannot unwind an
1075 exception by calling the <tt>C++</tt> exception throwing methods, but may
1076 use the <tt>unwind</tt> instruction.</dd>
Anton Korobeynikovc5ec8a72009-07-17 18:07:26 +00001077
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001078 <dt><tt><a name="ssp">ssp</a></tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001079 <dd>This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack smashing
1080 protector. It is in the form of a "canary"&mdash;a random value placed on
1081 the stack before the local variables that's checked upon return from the
1082 function to see if it has been overwritten. A heuristic is used to
1083 determine if a function needs stack protectors or not.<br>
1084<br>
1085 If a function that has an <tt>ssp</tt> attribute is inlined into a
1086 function that doesn't have an <tt>ssp</tt> attribute, then the resulting
1087 function will have an <tt>ssp</tt> attribute.</dd>
1088
1089 <dt><tt>sspreq</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001090 <dd>This attribute indicates that the function should <em>always</em> emit a
1091 stack smashing protector. This overrides
Bill Wendlingc39e3e02009-07-20 02:39:26 +00001092 the <tt><a href="#ssp">ssp</a></tt> function attribute.<br>
1093<br>
1094 If a function that has an <tt>sspreq</tt> attribute is inlined into a
1095 function that doesn't have an <tt>sspreq</tt> attribute or which has
1096 an <tt>ssp</tt> attribute, then the resulting function will have
1097 an <tt>sspreq</tt> attribute.</dd>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001098
1099 <dt><tt>noredzone</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001100 <dd>This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use a red
1101 zone, even if the target-specific ABI normally permits it.</dd>
1102
1103 <dt><tt>noimplicitfloat</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001104 <dd>This attributes disables implicit floating point instructions.</dd>
1105
1106 <dt><tt>naked</tt></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001107 <dd>This attribute disables prologue / epilogue emission for the function.
1108 This can have very system-specific consequences.</dd>
Bill Wendlinge36dccc2008-09-07 10:26:33 +00001109</dl>
1110
Devang Patelf8b94812008-09-04 23:05:13 +00001111</div>
1112
1113<!-- ======================================================================= -->
1114<div class="doc_subsection">
Chris Lattner1eeeb0c2006-04-08 04:40:53 +00001115 <a name="moduleasm">Module-Level Inline Assembly</a>
Chris Lattner4e9aba72006-01-23 23:23:47 +00001116</div>
1117
1118<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001119
1120<p>Modules may contain "module-level inline asm" blocks, which corresponds to
1121 the GCC "file scope inline asm" blocks. These blocks are internally
1122 concatenated by LLVM and treated as a single unit, but may be separated in
1123 the <tt>.ll</tt> file if desired. The syntax is very simple:</p>
Chris Lattner4e9aba72006-01-23 23:23:47 +00001124
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00001125<div class="doc_code">
1126<pre>
1127module asm "inline asm code goes here"
1128module asm "more can go here"
1129</pre>
1130</div>
Chris Lattner4e9aba72006-01-23 23:23:47 +00001131
1132<p>The strings can contain any character by escaping non-printable characters.
1133 The escape sequence used is simply "\xx" where "xx" is the two digit hex code
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001134 for the number.</p>
Chris Lattner4e9aba72006-01-23 23:23:47 +00001135
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001136<p>The inline asm code is simply printed to the machine code .s file when
1137 assembly code is generated.</p>
1138
Chris Lattner4e9aba72006-01-23 23:23:47 +00001139</div>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +00001140
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001141<!-- ======================================================================= -->
1142<div class="doc_subsection">
1143 <a name="datalayout">Data Layout</a>
1144</div>
1145
1146<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001147
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001148<p>A module may specify a target specific data layout string that specifies how
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001149 data is to be laid out in memory. The syntax for the data layout is
1150 simply:</p>
1151
1152<div class="doc_code">
1153<pre>
1154target datalayout = "<i>layout specification</i>"
1155</pre>
1156</div>
1157
1158<p>The <i>layout specification</i> consists of a list of specifications
1159 separated by the minus sign character ('-'). Each specification starts with
1160 a letter and may include other information after the letter to define some
1161 aspect of the data layout. The specifications accepted are as follows:</p>
1162
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001163<dl>
1164 <dt><tt>E</tt></dt>
1165 <dd>Specifies that the target lays out data in big-endian form. That is, the
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001166 bits with the most significance have the lowest address location.</dd>
1167
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001168 <dt><tt>e</tt></dt>
Chris Lattnerd3eda892008-08-05 18:29:16 +00001169 <dd>Specifies that the target lays out data in little-endian form. That is,
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001170 the bits with the least significance have the lowest address
1171 location.</dd>
1172
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001173 <dt><tt>p:<i>size</i>:<i>abi</i>:<i>pref</i></tt></dt>
1174 <dd>This specifies the <i>size</i> of a pointer and its <i>abi</i> and
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001175 <i>preferred</i> alignments. All sizes are in bits. Specifying
1176 the <i>pref</i> alignment is optional. If omitted, the
1177 preceding <tt>:</tt> should be omitted too.</dd>
1178
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001179 <dt><tt>i<i>size</i>:<i>abi</i>:<i>pref</i></tt></dt>
1180 <dd>This specifies the alignment for an integer type of a given bit
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001181 <i>size</i>. The value of <i>size</i> must be in the range [1,2^23).</dd>
1182
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001183 <dt><tt>v<i>size</i>:<i>abi</i>:<i>pref</i></tt></dt>
1184 <dd>This specifies the alignment for a vector type of a given bit
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001185 <i>size</i>.</dd>
1186
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001187 <dt><tt>f<i>size</i>:<i>abi</i>:<i>pref</i></tt></dt>
1188 <dd>This specifies the alignment for a floating point type of a given bit
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001189 <i>size</i>. The value of <i>size</i> must be either 32 (float) or 64
1190 (double).</dd>
1191
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001192 <dt><tt>a<i>size</i>:<i>abi</i>:<i>pref</i></tt></dt>
1193 <dd>This specifies the alignment for an aggregate type of a given bit
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001194 <i>size</i>.</dd>
1195
Daniel Dunbar87bde0b2009-06-08 22:17:53 +00001196 <dt><tt>s<i>size</i>:<i>abi</i>:<i>pref</i></tt></dt>
1197 <dd>This specifies the alignment for a stack object of a given bit
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001198 <i>size</i>.</dd>
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001199</dl>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001200
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001201<p>When constructing the data layout for a given target, LLVM starts with a
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001202 default set of specifications which are then (possibly) overriden by the
1203 specifications in the <tt>datalayout</tt> keyword. The default specifications
1204 are given in this list:</p>
1205
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001206<ul>
1207 <li><tt>E</tt> - big endian</li>
1208 <li><tt>p:32:64:64</tt> - 32-bit pointers with 64-bit alignment</li>
1209 <li><tt>i1:8:8</tt> - i1 is 8-bit (byte) aligned</li>
1210 <li><tt>i8:8:8</tt> - i8 is 8-bit (byte) aligned</li>
1211 <li><tt>i16:16:16</tt> - i16 is 16-bit aligned</li>
1212 <li><tt>i32:32:32</tt> - i32 is 32-bit aligned</li>
Chris Lattnerd3eda892008-08-05 18:29:16 +00001213 <li><tt>i64:32:64</tt> - i64 has ABI alignment of 32-bits but preferred
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001214 alignment of 64-bits</li>
1215 <li><tt>f32:32:32</tt> - float is 32-bit aligned</li>
1216 <li><tt>f64:64:64</tt> - double is 64-bit aligned</li>
1217 <li><tt>v64:64:64</tt> - 64-bit vector is 64-bit aligned</li>
1218 <li><tt>v128:128:128</tt> - 128-bit vector is 128-bit aligned</li>
1219 <li><tt>a0:0:1</tt> - aggregates are 8-bit aligned</li>
Daniel Dunbar87bde0b2009-06-08 22:17:53 +00001220 <li><tt>s0:64:64</tt> - stack objects are 64-bit aligned</li>
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001221</ul>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001222
1223<p>When LLVM is determining the alignment for a given type, it uses the
1224 following rules:</p>
1225
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001226<ol>
1227 <li>If the type sought is an exact match for one of the specifications, that
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001228 specification is used.</li>
1229
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001230 <li>If no match is found, and the type sought is an integer type, then the
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001231 smallest integer type that is larger than the bitwidth of the sought type
1232 is used. If none of the specifications are larger than the bitwidth then
1233 the the largest integer type is used. For example, given the default
1234 specifications above, the i7 type will use the alignment of i8 (next
1235 largest) while both i65 and i256 will use the alignment of i64 (largest
1236 specified).</li>
1237
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001238 <li>If no match is found, and the type sought is a vector type, then the
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001239 largest vector type that is smaller than the sought vector type will be
1240 used as a fall back. This happens because &lt;128 x double&gt; can be
1241 implemented in terms of 64 &lt;2 x double&gt;, for example.</li>
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001242</ol>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001243
Reid Spencerde151942007-02-19 23:54:10 +00001244</div>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +00001245
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001246<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00001247<div class="doc_section"> <a name="typesystem">Type System</a> </div>
1248<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +00001249
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001250<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +00001251
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001252<p>The LLVM type system is one of the most important features of the
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001253 intermediate representation. Being typed enables a number of optimizations
1254 to be performed on the intermediate representation directly, without having
1255 to do extra analyses on the side before the transformation. A strong type
1256 system makes it easier to read the generated code and enables novel analyses
1257 and transformations that are not feasible to perform on normal three address
1258 code representations.</p>
Chris Lattnerfa730212004-12-09 16:11:40 +00001259
1260</div>
1261
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001262<!-- ======================================================================= -->
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001263<div class="doc_subsection"> <a name="t_classifications">Type
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00001264Classifications</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001265
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001266<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001267
1268<p>The types fall into a few useful classifications:</p>
Misha Brukmandaa4cb02004-03-01 17:47:27 +00001269
1270<table border="1" cellspacing="0" cellpadding="4">
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00001271 <tbody>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001272 <tr><th>Classification</th><th>Types</th></tr>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00001273 <tr>
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001274 <td><a href="#t_integer">integer</a></td>
Reid Spencer2b916312007-05-16 18:44:01 +00001275 <td><tt>i1, i2, i3, ... i8, ... i16, ... i32, ... i64, ... </tt></td>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00001276 </tr>
1277 <tr>
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001278 <td><a href="#t_floating">floating point</a></td>
1279 <td><tt>float, double, x86_fp80, fp128, ppc_fp128</tt></td>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00001280 </tr>
1281 <tr>
1282 <td><a name="t_firstclass">first class</a></td>
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001283 <td><a href="#t_integer">integer</a>,
1284 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a>,
1285 <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a>,
Dan Gohman0066db62008-06-18 18:42:13 +00001286 <a href="#t_vector">vector</a>,
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00001287 <a href="#t_struct">structure</a>,
1288 <a href="#t_array">array</a>,
Nick Lewycky7a0370f2009-05-30 05:06:04 +00001289 <a href="#t_label">label</a>,
1290 <a href="#t_metadata">metadata</a>.
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00001291 </td>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00001292 </tr>
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001293 <tr>
1294 <td><a href="#t_primitive">primitive</a></td>
1295 <td><a href="#t_label">label</a>,
1296 <a href="#t_void">void</a>,
Nick Lewycky7a0370f2009-05-30 05:06:04 +00001297 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a>,
1298 <a href="#t_metadata">metadata</a>.</td>
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001299 </tr>
1300 <tr>
1301 <td><a href="#t_derived">derived</a></td>
1302 <td><a href="#t_integer">integer</a>,
1303 <a href="#t_array">array</a>,
1304 <a href="#t_function">function</a>,
1305 <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a>,
1306 <a href="#t_struct">structure</a>,
1307 <a href="#t_pstruct">packed structure</a>,
1308 <a href="#t_vector">vector</a>,
1309 <a href="#t_opaque">opaque</a>.
Dan Gohman01ac1012008-10-14 16:32:04 +00001310 </td>
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001311 </tr>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00001312 </tbody>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001313</table>
Misha Brukmandaa4cb02004-03-01 17:47:27 +00001314
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001315<p>The <a href="#t_firstclass">first class</a> types are perhaps the most
1316 important. Values of these types are the only ones which can be produced by
1317 instructions, passed as arguments, or used as operands to instructions.</p>
1318
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001319</div>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001320
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001321<!-- ======================================================================= -->
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001322<div class="doc_subsection"> <a name="t_primitive">Primitive Types</a> </div>
Chris Lattner8f8c7b72008-01-04 04:34:14 +00001323
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001324<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001325
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001326<p>The primitive types are the fundamental building blocks of the LLVM
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001327 system.</p>
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001328
Chris Lattner8f8c7b72008-01-04 04:34:14 +00001329</div>
1330
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001331<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
1332<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="t_floating">Floating Point Types</a> </div>
1333
1334<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001335
1336<table>
1337 <tbody>
1338 <tr><th>Type</th><th>Description</th></tr>
1339 <tr><td><tt>float</tt></td><td>32-bit floating point value</td></tr>
1340 <tr><td><tt>double</tt></td><td>64-bit floating point value</td></tr>
1341 <tr><td><tt>fp128</tt></td><td>128-bit floating point value (112-bit mantissa)</td></tr>
1342 <tr><td><tt>x86_fp80</tt></td><td>80-bit floating point value (X87)</td></tr>
1343 <tr><td><tt>ppc_fp128</tt></td><td>128-bit floating point value (two 64-bits)</td></tr>
1344 </tbody>
1345</table>
1346
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001347</div>
1348
1349<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
1350<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="t_void">Void Type</a> </div>
1351
1352<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlingc39e3e02009-07-20 02:39:26 +00001353
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001354<h5>Overview:</h5>
1355<p>The void type does not represent any value and has no size.</p>
1356
1357<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001358<pre>
1359 void
1360</pre>
Bill Wendlingc39e3e02009-07-20 02:39:26 +00001361
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001362</div>
1363
1364<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
1365<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="t_label">Label Type</a> </div>
1366
1367<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlingc39e3e02009-07-20 02:39:26 +00001368
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001369<h5>Overview:</h5>
1370<p>The label type represents code labels.</p>
1371
1372<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001373<pre>
1374 label
1375</pre>
Bill Wendlingc39e3e02009-07-20 02:39:26 +00001376
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001377</div>
1378
Nick Lewycky7a0370f2009-05-30 05:06:04 +00001379<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
1380<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="t_metadata">Metadata Type</a> </div>
1381
1382<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlingc39e3e02009-07-20 02:39:26 +00001383
Nick Lewycky7a0370f2009-05-30 05:06:04 +00001384<h5>Overview:</h5>
1385<p>The metadata type represents embedded metadata. The only derived type that
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001386 may contain metadata is <tt>metadata*</tt> or a function type that returns or
1387 takes metadata typed parameters, but not pointer to metadata types.</p>
Nick Lewycky7a0370f2009-05-30 05:06:04 +00001388
1389<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Nick Lewycky7a0370f2009-05-30 05:06:04 +00001390<pre>
1391 metadata
1392</pre>
Bill Wendlingc39e3e02009-07-20 02:39:26 +00001393
Nick Lewycky7a0370f2009-05-30 05:06:04 +00001394</div>
1395
Chris Lattner4f69f462008-01-04 04:32:38 +00001396
1397<!-- ======================================================================= -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00001398<div class="doc_subsection"> <a name="t_derived">Derived Types</a> </div>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001399
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001400<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001401
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001402<p>The real power in LLVM comes from the derived types in the system. This is
1403 what allows a programmer to represent arrays, functions, pointers, and other
1404 useful types. Note that these derived types may be recursive: For example,
1405 it is possible to have a two dimensional array.</p>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001406
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001407</div>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001408
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001409<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Reid Spencer2b916312007-05-16 18:44:01 +00001410<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="t_integer">Integer Type</a> </div>
1411
1412<div class="doc_text">
1413
1414<h5>Overview:</h5>
1415<p>The integer type is a very simple derived type that simply specifies an
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001416 arbitrary bit width for the integer type desired. Any bit width from 1 bit to
1417 2^23-1 (about 8 million) can be specified.</p>
Reid Spencer2b916312007-05-16 18:44:01 +00001418
1419<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Reid Spencer2b916312007-05-16 18:44:01 +00001420<pre>
1421 iN
1422</pre>
1423
1424<p>The number of bits the integer will occupy is specified by the <tt>N</tt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001425 value.</p>
Reid Spencer2b916312007-05-16 18:44:01 +00001426
1427<h5>Examples:</h5>
1428<table class="layout">
Nick Lewycky86c48642009-05-24 02:46:06 +00001429 <tr class="layout">
1430 <td class="left"><tt>i1</tt></td>
1431 <td class="left">a single-bit integer.</td>
Reid Spencer2b916312007-05-16 18:44:01 +00001432 </tr>
Nick Lewycky86c48642009-05-24 02:46:06 +00001433 <tr class="layout">
1434 <td class="left"><tt>i32</tt></td>
1435 <td class="left">a 32-bit integer.</td>
1436 </tr>
1437 <tr class="layout">
1438 <td class="left"><tt>i1942652</tt></td>
1439 <td class="left">a really big integer of over 1 million bits.</td>
1440 </tr>
Reid Spencer2b916312007-05-16 18:44:01 +00001441</table>
Dan Gohmand8791e52009-01-24 15:58:40 +00001442
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001443<p>Note that the code generator does not yet support large integer types to be
1444 used as function return types. The specific limit on how large a return type
1445 the code generator can currently handle is target-dependent; currently it's
1446 often 64 bits for 32-bit targets and 128 bits for 64-bit targets.</p>
Dan Gohmand8791e52009-01-24 15:58:40 +00001447
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00001448</div>
Reid Spencer2b916312007-05-16 18:44:01 +00001449
1450<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00001451<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="t_array">Array Type</a> </div>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001452
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001453<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001454
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001455<h5>Overview:</h5>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001456<p>The array type is a very simple derived type that arranges elements
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001457 sequentially in memory. The array type requires a size (number of elements)
1458 and an underlying data type.</p>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001459
Chris Lattner7faa8832002-04-14 06:13:44 +00001460<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001461<pre>
1462 [&lt;# elements&gt; x &lt;elementtype&gt;]
1463</pre>
1464
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001465<p>The number of elements is a constant integer value; <tt>elementtype</tt> may
1466 be any type with a size.</p>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001467
Chris Lattner7faa8832002-04-14 06:13:44 +00001468<h5>Examples:</h5>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001469<table class="layout">
1470 <tr class="layout">
Chris Lattner23ff1f92007-12-19 05:04:11 +00001471 <td class="left"><tt>[40 x i32]</tt></td>
1472 <td class="left">Array of 40 32-bit integer values.</td>
1473 </tr>
1474 <tr class="layout">
1475 <td class="left"><tt>[41 x i32]</tt></td>
1476 <td class="left">Array of 41 32-bit integer values.</td>
1477 </tr>
1478 <tr class="layout">
1479 <td class="left"><tt>[4 x i8]</tt></td>
1480 <td class="left">Array of 4 8-bit integer values.</td>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001481 </tr>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001482</table>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001483<p>Here are some examples of multidimensional arrays:</p>
1484<table class="layout">
1485 <tr class="layout">
Chris Lattner23ff1f92007-12-19 05:04:11 +00001486 <td class="left"><tt>[3 x [4 x i32]]</tt></td>
1487 <td class="left">3x4 array of 32-bit integer values.</td>
1488 </tr>
1489 <tr class="layout">
1490 <td class="left"><tt>[12 x [10 x float]]</tt></td>
1491 <td class="left">12x10 array of single precision floating point values.</td>
1492 </tr>
1493 <tr class="layout">
1494 <td class="left"><tt>[2 x [3 x [4 x i16]]]</tt></td>
1495 <td class="left">2x3x4 array of 16-bit integer values.</td>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001496 </tr>
1497</table>
Chris Lattnere67a9512005-06-24 17:22:57 +00001498
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001499<p>Note that 'variable sized arrays' can be implemented in LLVM with a zero
1500 length array. Normally, accesses past the end of an array are undefined in
1501 LLVM (e.g. it is illegal to access the 5th element of a 3 element array). As
1502 a special case, however, zero length arrays are recognized to be variable
1503 length. This allows implementation of 'pascal style arrays' with the LLVM
1504 type "<tt>{ i32, [0 x float]}</tt>", for example.</p>
Chris Lattnere67a9512005-06-24 17:22:57 +00001505
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001506<p>Note that the code generator does not yet support large aggregate types to be
1507 used as function return types. The specific limit on how large an aggregate
1508 return type the code generator can currently handle is target-dependent, and
1509 also dependent on the aggregate element types.</p>
Dan Gohmand8791e52009-01-24 15:58:40 +00001510
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001511</div>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001512
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001513<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00001514<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="t_function">Function Type</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001515
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001516<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerf4cde4e2008-04-23 04:59:35 +00001517
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001518<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001519<p>The function type can be thought of as a function signature. It consists of
1520 a return type and a list of formal parameter types. The return type of a
1521 function type is a scalar type, a void type, or a struct type. If the return
1522 type is a struct type then all struct elements must be of first class types,
1523 and the struct must have at least one element.</p>
Devang Patelc3fc6df2008-03-10 20:49:15 +00001524
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001525<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattnerf4cde4e2008-04-23 04:59:35 +00001526<pre>
1527 &lt;returntype list&gt; (&lt;parameter list&gt;)
1528</pre>
1529
John Criswell0ec250c2005-10-24 16:17:18 +00001530<p>...where '<tt>&lt;parameter list&gt;</tt>' is a comma-separated list of type
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001531 specifiers. Optionally, the parameter list may include a type <tt>...</tt>,
1532 which indicates that the function takes a variable number of arguments.
1533 Variable argument functions can access their arguments with
1534 the <a href="#int_varargs">variable argument handling intrinsic</a>
1535 functions. '<tt>&lt;returntype list&gt;</tt>' is a comma-separated list of
1536 <a href="#t_firstclass">first class</a> type specifiers.</p>
Chris Lattnerf4cde4e2008-04-23 04:59:35 +00001537
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001538<h5>Examples:</h5>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001539<table class="layout">
1540 <tr class="layout">
Reid Spencer92f82302006-12-31 07:18:34 +00001541 <td class="left"><tt>i32 (i32)</tt></td>
1542 <td class="left">function taking an <tt>i32</tt>, returning an <tt>i32</tt>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001543 </td>
Reid Spencer92f82302006-12-31 07:18:34 +00001544 </tr><tr class="layout">
Reid Spencer9445e9a2007-07-19 23:13:04 +00001545 <td class="left"><tt>float&nbsp;(i16&nbsp;signext,&nbsp;i32&nbsp;*)&nbsp;*
Reid Spencerf17a0b72006-12-31 07:20:23 +00001546 </tt></td>
Reid Spencer92f82302006-12-31 07:18:34 +00001547 <td class="left"><a href="#t_pointer">Pointer</a> to a function that takes
1548 an <tt>i16</tt> that should be sign extended and a
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00001549 <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a> to <tt>i32</tt>, returning
Reid Spencer92f82302006-12-31 07:18:34 +00001550 <tt>float</tt>.
1551 </td>
1552 </tr><tr class="layout">
1553 <td class="left"><tt>i32 (i8*, ...)</tt></td>
1554 <td class="left">A vararg function that takes at least one
Reid Spencera5173382007-01-04 16:43:23 +00001555 <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a> to <tt>i8 </tt> (char in C),
Reid Spencer92f82302006-12-31 07:18:34 +00001556 which returns an integer. This is the signature for <tt>printf</tt> in
1557 LLVM.
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001558 </td>
Devang Patela582f402008-03-24 05:35:41 +00001559 </tr><tr class="layout">
1560 <td class="left"><tt>{i32, i32} (i32)</tt></td>
Misha Brukmanb0a57aa2008-11-27 06:41:20 +00001561 <td class="left">A function taking an <tt>i32</tt>, returning two
1562 <tt>i32</tt> values as an aggregate of type <tt>{ i32, i32 }</tt>
Devang Patela582f402008-03-24 05:35:41 +00001563 </td>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001564 </tr>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001565</table>
Misha Brukmandaa4cb02004-03-01 17:47:27 +00001566
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001567</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001568
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001569<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00001570<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="t_struct">Structure Type</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001571
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001572<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001573
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001574<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001575<p>The structure type is used to represent a collection of data members together
1576 in memory. The packing of the field types is defined to match the ABI of the
1577 underlying processor. The elements of a structure may be any type that has a
1578 size.</p>
1579
1580<p>Structures are accessed using '<tt><a href="#i_load">load</a></tt> and
1581 '<tt><a href="#i_store">store</a></tt>' by getting a pointer to a field with
1582 the '<tt><a href="#i_getelementptr">getelementptr</a></tt>' instruction.</p>
1583
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001584<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlingc39e3e02009-07-20 02:39:26 +00001585<pre>
1586 { &lt;type list&gt; }
1587</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001588
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001589<h5>Examples:</h5>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001590<table class="layout">
1591 <tr class="layout">
Jeff Cohen6f1cc772007-04-22 01:17:39 +00001592 <td class="left"><tt>{ i32, i32, i32 }</tt></td>
1593 <td class="left">A triple of three <tt>i32</tt> values</td>
1594 </tr><tr class="layout">
1595 <td class="left"><tt>{&nbsp;float,&nbsp;i32&nbsp;(i32)&nbsp;*&nbsp;}</tt></td>
1596 <td class="left">A pair, where the first element is a <tt>float</tt> and the
1597 second element is a <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a> to a
1598 <a href="#t_function">function</a> that takes an <tt>i32</tt>, returning
1599 an <tt>i32</tt>.</td>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001600 </tr>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001601</table>
Dan Gohmand8791e52009-01-24 15:58:40 +00001602
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001603<p>Note that the code generator does not yet support large aggregate types to be
1604 used as function return types. The specific limit on how large an aggregate
1605 return type the code generator can currently handle is target-dependent, and
1606 also dependent on the aggregate element types.</p>
Dan Gohmand8791e52009-01-24 15:58:40 +00001607
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001608</div>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001609
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00001610<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Andrew Lenharth75e10682006-12-08 17:13:00 +00001611<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="t_pstruct">Packed Structure Type</a>
1612</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001613
Andrew Lenharth75e10682006-12-08 17:13:00 +00001614<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001615
Andrew Lenharth75e10682006-12-08 17:13:00 +00001616<h5>Overview:</h5>
1617<p>The packed structure type is used to represent a collection of data members
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001618 together in memory. There is no padding between fields. Further, the
1619 alignment of a packed structure is 1 byte. The elements of a packed
1620 structure may be any type that has a size.</p>
1621
1622<p>Structures are accessed using '<tt><a href="#i_load">load</a></tt> and
1623 '<tt><a href="#i_store">store</a></tt>' by getting a pointer to a field with
1624 the '<tt><a href="#i_getelementptr">getelementptr</a></tt>' instruction.</p>
1625
Andrew Lenharth75e10682006-12-08 17:13:00 +00001626<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlingc39e3e02009-07-20 02:39:26 +00001627<pre>
1628 &lt; { &lt;type list&gt; } &gt;
1629</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001630
Andrew Lenharth75e10682006-12-08 17:13:00 +00001631<h5>Examples:</h5>
1632<table class="layout">
1633 <tr class="layout">
Jeff Cohen6f1cc772007-04-22 01:17:39 +00001634 <td class="left"><tt>&lt; { i32, i32, i32 } &gt;</tt></td>
1635 <td class="left">A triple of three <tt>i32</tt> values</td>
1636 </tr><tr class="layout">
Bill Wendlinge36dccc2008-09-07 10:26:33 +00001637 <td class="left">
1638<tt>&lt;&nbsp;{&nbsp;float,&nbsp;i32&nbsp;(i32)*&nbsp;}&nbsp;&gt;</tt></td>
Jeff Cohen6f1cc772007-04-22 01:17:39 +00001639 <td class="left">A pair, where the first element is a <tt>float</tt> and the
1640 second element is a <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a> to a
1641 <a href="#t_function">function</a> that takes an <tt>i32</tt>, returning
1642 an <tt>i32</tt>.</td>
Andrew Lenharth75e10682006-12-08 17:13:00 +00001643 </tr>
1644</table>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001645
Andrew Lenharth75e10682006-12-08 17:13:00 +00001646</div>
1647
1648<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00001649<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="t_pointer">Pointer Type</a> </div>
Chris Lattner0fd4a272009-02-08 19:53:29 +00001650
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001651<div class="doc_text">
1652
1653<h5>Overview:</h5>
1654<p>As in many languages, the pointer type represents a pointer or reference to
1655 another object, which must live in memory. Pointer types may have an optional
1656 address space attribute defining the target-specific numbered address space
1657 where the pointed-to object resides. The default address space is zero.</p>
1658
1659<p>Note that LLVM does not permit pointers to void (<tt>void*</tt>) nor does it
1660 permit pointers to labels (<tt>label*</tt>). Use <tt>i8*</tt> instead.</p>
Chris Lattner0fd4a272009-02-08 19:53:29 +00001661
Chris Lattner7faa8832002-04-14 06:13:44 +00001662<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlingc39e3e02009-07-20 02:39:26 +00001663<pre>
1664 &lt;type&gt; *
1665</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001666
Chris Lattner7faa8832002-04-14 06:13:44 +00001667<h5>Examples:</h5>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001668<table class="layout">
1669 <tr class="layout">
Dan Gohman2a08c532009-01-04 23:44:43 +00001670 <td class="left"><tt>[4 x i32]*</tt></td>
Chris Lattner23ff1f92007-12-19 05:04:11 +00001671 <td class="left">A <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a> to <a
1672 href="#t_array">array</a> of four <tt>i32</tt> values.</td>
1673 </tr>
1674 <tr class="layout">
1675 <td class="left"><tt>i32 (i32 *) *</tt></td>
1676 <td class="left"> A <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a> to a <a
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00001677 href="#t_function">function</a> that takes an <tt>i32*</tt>, returning an
Chris Lattner23ff1f92007-12-19 05:04:11 +00001678 <tt>i32</tt>.</td>
1679 </tr>
1680 <tr class="layout">
1681 <td class="left"><tt>i32 addrspace(5)*</tt></td>
1682 <td class="left">A <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a> to an <tt>i32</tt> value
1683 that resides in address space #5.</td>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001684 </tr>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001685</table>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001686
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001687</div>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001688
Chris Lattnera58561b2004-08-12 19:12:28 +00001689<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Reid Spencer485bad12007-02-15 03:07:05 +00001690<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="t_vector">Vector Type</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001691
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001692<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner69c11bb2005-04-25 17:34:15 +00001693
Chris Lattnera58561b2004-08-12 19:12:28 +00001694<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001695<p>A vector type is a simple derived type that represents a vector of elements.
1696 Vector types are used when multiple primitive data are operated in parallel
1697 using a single instruction (SIMD). A vector type requires a size (number of
1698 elements) and an underlying primitive data type. Vectors must have a power
1699 of two length (1, 2, 4, 8, 16 ...). Vector types are considered
1700 <a href="#t_firstclass">first class</a>.</p>
Chris Lattner69c11bb2005-04-25 17:34:15 +00001701
Chris Lattnera58561b2004-08-12 19:12:28 +00001702<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner69c11bb2005-04-25 17:34:15 +00001703<pre>
1704 &lt; &lt;# elements&gt; x &lt;elementtype&gt; &gt;
1705</pre>
1706
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001707<p>The number of elements is a constant integer value; elementtype may be any
1708 integer or floating point type.</p>
Chris Lattner69c11bb2005-04-25 17:34:15 +00001709
Chris Lattnera58561b2004-08-12 19:12:28 +00001710<h5>Examples:</h5>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001711<table class="layout">
1712 <tr class="layout">
Chris Lattner23ff1f92007-12-19 05:04:11 +00001713 <td class="left"><tt>&lt;4 x i32&gt;</tt></td>
1714 <td class="left">Vector of 4 32-bit integer values.</td>
1715 </tr>
1716 <tr class="layout">
1717 <td class="left"><tt>&lt;8 x float&gt;</tt></td>
1718 <td class="left">Vector of 8 32-bit floating-point values.</td>
1719 </tr>
1720 <tr class="layout">
1721 <td class="left"><tt>&lt;2 x i64&gt;</tt></td>
1722 <td class="left">Vector of 2 64-bit integer values.</td>
Reid Spencerd3f876c2004-11-01 08:19:36 +00001723 </tr>
1724</table>
Dan Gohmand8791e52009-01-24 15:58:40 +00001725
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001726<p>Note that the code generator does not yet support large vector types to be
1727 used as function return types. The specific limit on how large a vector
1728 return type codegen can currently handle is target-dependent; currently it's
1729 often a few times longer than a hardware vector register.</p>
Dan Gohmand8791e52009-01-24 15:58:40 +00001730
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00001731</div>
1732
Chris Lattner69c11bb2005-04-25 17:34:15 +00001733<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
1734<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="t_opaque">Opaque Type</a> </div>
1735<div class="doc_text">
1736
1737<h5>Overview:</h5>
Chris Lattner69c11bb2005-04-25 17:34:15 +00001738<p>Opaque types are used to represent unknown types in the system. This
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001739 corresponds (for example) to the C notion of a forward declared structure
1740 type. In LLVM, opaque types can eventually be resolved to any type (not just
1741 a structure type).</p>
Chris Lattner69c11bb2005-04-25 17:34:15 +00001742
1743<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner69c11bb2005-04-25 17:34:15 +00001744<pre>
1745 opaque
1746</pre>
1747
1748<h5>Examples:</h5>
Chris Lattner69c11bb2005-04-25 17:34:15 +00001749<table class="layout">
1750 <tr class="layout">
Chris Lattner23ff1f92007-12-19 05:04:11 +00001751 <td class="left"><tt>opaque</tt></td>
1752 <td class="left">An opaque type.</td>
Chris Lattner69c11bb2005-04-25 17:34:15 +00001753 </tr>
1754</table>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001755
Chris Lattner69c11bb2005-04-25 17:34:15 +00001756</div>
1757
Chris Lattner242d61d2009-02-02 07:32:36 +00001758<!-- ======================================================================= -->
1759<div class="doc_subsection">
1760 <a name="t_uprefs">Type Up-references</a>
1761</div>
1762
1763<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001764
Chris Lattner242d61d2009-02-02 07:32:36 +00001765<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001766<p>An "up reference" allows you to refer to a lexically enclosing type without
1767 requiring it to have a name. For instance, a structure declaration may
1768 contain a pointer to any of the types it is lexically a member of. Example
1769 of up references (with their equivalent as named type declarations)
1770 include:</p>
Chris Lattner242d61d2009-02-02 07:32:36 +00001771
1772<pre>
Chris Lattner3060f5b2009-02-09 10:00:56 +00001773 { \2 * } %x = type { %x* }
Chris Lattner242d61d2009-02-02 07:32:36 +00001774 { \2 }* %y = type { %y }*
1775 \1* %z = type %z*
1776</pre>
1777
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001778<p>An up reference is needed by the asmprinter for printing out cyclic types
1779 when there is no declared name for a type in the cycle. Because the
1780 asmprinter does not want to print out an infinite type string, it needs a
1781 syntax to handle recursive types that have no names (all names are optional
1782 in llvm IR).</p>
Chris Lattner242d61d2009-02-02 07:32:36 +00001783
1784<h5>Syntax:</h5>
1785<pre>
1786 \&lt;level&gt;
1787</pre>
1788
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001789<p>The level is the count of the lexical type that is being referred to.</p>
Chris Lattner242d61d2009-02-02 07:32:36 +00001790
1791<h5>Examples:</h5>
Chris Lattner242d61d2009-02-02 07:32:36 +00001792<table class="layout">
1793 <tr class="layout">
1794 <td class="left"><tt>\1*</tt></td>
1795 <td class="left">Self-referential pointer.</td>
1796 </tr>
1797 <tr class="layout">
1798 <td class="left"><tt>{ { \3*, i8 }, i32 }</tt></td>
1799 <td class="left">Recursive structure where the upref refers to the out-most
1800 structure.</td>
1801 </tr>
1802</table>
Chris Lattner242d61d2009-02-02 07:32:36 +00001803
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001804</div>
Chris Lattner69c11bb2005-04-25 17:34:15 +00001805
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001806<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
1807<div class="doc_section"> <a name="constants">Constants</a> </div>
1808<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
1809
1810<div class="doc_text">
1811
1812<p>LLVM has several different basic types of constants. This section describes
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001813 them all and their syntax.</p>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001814
1815</div>
1816
1817<!-- ======================================================================= -->
Reid Spencercc16dc32004-12-09 18:02:53 +00001818<div class="doc_subsection"><a name="simpleconstants">Simple Constants</a></div>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001819
1820<div class="doc_text">
1821
1822<dl>
1823 <dt><b>Boolean constants</b></dt>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001824 <dd>The two strings '<tt>true</tt>' and '<tt>false</tt>' are both valid
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001825 constants of the <tt><a href="#t_primitive">i1</a></tt> type.</dd>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001826
1827 <dt><b>Integer constants</b></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001828 <dd>Standard integers (such as '4') are constants of
1829 the <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> type. Negative numbers may be used
1830 with integer types.</dd>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001831
1832 <dt><b>Floating point constants</b></dt>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001833 <dd>Floating point constants use standard decimal notation (e.g. 123.421),
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001834 exponential notation (e.g. 1.23421e+2), or a more precise hexadecimal
1835 notation (see below). The assembler requires the exact decimal value of a
1836 floating-point constant. For example, the assembler accepts 1.25 but
1837 rejects 1.3 because 1.3 is a repeating decimal in binary. Floating point
1838 constants must have a <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> type. </dd>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001839
1840 <dt><b>Null pointer constants</b></dt>
John Criswell9e2485c2004-12-10 15:51:16 +00001841 <dd>The identifier '<tt>null</tt>' is recognized as a null pointer constant
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001842 and must be of <a href="#t_pointer">pointer type</a>.</dd>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001843</dl>
1844
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001845<p>The one non-intuitive notation for constants is the hexadecimal form of
1846 floating point constants. For example, the form '<tt>double
1847 0x432ff973cafa8000</tt>' is equivalent to (but harder to read than)
1848 '<tt>double 4.5e+15</tt>'. The only time hexadecimal floating point
1849 constants are required (and the only time that they are generated by the
1850 disassembler) is when a floating point constant must be emitted but it cannot
1851 be represented as a decimal floating point number in a reasonable number of
1852 digits. For example, NaN's, infinities, and other special values are
1853 represented in their IEEE hexadecimal format so that assembly and disassembly
1854 do not cause any bits to change in the constants.</p>
1855
Dale Johannesenbd5e5a82009-02-11 22:14:51 +00001856<p>When using the hexadecimal form, constants of types float and double are
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001857 represented using the 16-digit form shown above (which matches the IEEE754
1858 representation for double); float values must, however, be exactly
1859 representable as IEE754 single precision. Hexadecimal format is always used
1860 for long double, and there are three forms of long double. The 80-bit format
1861 used by x86 is represented as <tt>0xK</tt> followed by 20 hexadecimal digits.
1862 The 128-bit format used by PowerPC (two adjacent doubles) is represented
1863 by <tt>0xM</tt> followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. The IEEE 128-bit format
1864 is represented by <tt>0xL</tt> followed by 32 hexadecimal digits; no
1865 currently supported target uses this format. Long doubles will only work if
1866 they match the long double format on your target. All hexadecimal formats
1867 are big-endian (sign bit at the left).</p>
1868
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001869</div>
1870
1871<!-- ======================================================================= -->
Chris Lattner70882792009-02-28 18:32:25 +00001872<div class="doc_subsection">
Bill Wendlingd9fe2982009-07-20 02:32:41 +00001873<a name="aggregateconstants"></a> <!-- old anchor -->
1874<a name="complexconstants">Complex Constants</a>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001875</div>
1876
1877<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001878
Chris Lattner70882792009-02-28 18:32:25 +00001879<p>Complex constants are a (potentially recursive) combination of simple
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001880 constants and smaller complex constants.</p>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001881
1882<dl>
1883 <dt><b>Structure constants</b></dt>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001884 <dd>Structure constants are represented with notation similar to structure
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001885 type definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by braces
1886 (<tt>{}</tt>)). For example: "<tt>{ i32 4, float 17.0, i32* @G }</tt>",
1887 where "<tt>@G</tt>" is declared as "<tt>@G = external global i32</tt>".
1888 Structure constants must have <a href="#t_struct">structure type</a>, and
1889 the number and types of elements must match those specified by the
1890 type.</dd>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001891
1892 <dt><b>Array constants</b></dt>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001893 <dd>Array constants are represented with notation similar to array type
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001894 definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by square
1895 brackets (<tt>[]</tt>)). For example: "<tt>[ i32 42, i32 11, i32 74
1896 ]</tt>". Array constants must have <a href="#t_array">array type</a>, and
1897 the number and types of elements must match those specified by the
1898 type.</dd>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001899
Reid Spencer485bad12007-02-15 03:07:05 +00001900 <dt><b>Vector constants</b></dt>
Reid Spencer485bad12007-02-15 03:07:05 +00001901 <dd>Vector constants are represented with notation similar to vector type
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001902 definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
1903 less-than/greater-than's (<tt>&lt;&gt;</tt>)). For example: "<tt>&lt; i32
1904 42, i32 11, i32 74, i32 100 &gt;</tt>". Vector constants must
1905 have <a href="#t_vector">vector type</a>, and the number and types of
1906 elements must match those specified by the type.</dd>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001907
1908 <dt><b>Zero initialization</b></dt>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001909 <dd>The string '<tt>zeroinitializer</tt>' can be used to zero initialize a
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001910 value to zero of <em>any</em> type, including scalar and aggregate types.
1911 This is often used to avoid having to print large zero initializers
1912 (e.g. for large arrays) and is always exactly equivalent to using explicit
1913 zero initializers.</dd>
Nick Lewycky21cc4462009-04-04 07:22:01 +00001914
1915 <dt><b>Metadata node</b></dt>
Nick Lewycky1e8c7a62009-05-30 16:08:30 +00001916 <dd>A metadata node is a structure-like constant with
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001917 <a href="#t_metadata">metadata type</a>. For example: "<tt>metadata !{
1918 i32 0, metadata !"test" }</tt>". Unlike other constants that are meant to
1919 be interpreted as part of the instruction stream, metadata is a place to
1920 attach additional information such as debug info.</dd>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001921</dl>
1922
1923</div>
1924
1925<!-- ======================================================================= -->
1926<div class="doc_subsection">
1927 <a name="globalconstants">Global Variable and Function Addresses</a>
1928</div>
1929
1930<div class="doc_text">
1931
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001932<p>The addresses of <a href="#globalvars">global variables</a>
1933 and <a href="#functionstructure">functions</a> are always implicitly valid
1934 (link-time) constants. These constants are explicitly referenced when
1935 the <a href="#identifiers">identifier for the global</a> is used and always
1936 have <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a> type. For example, the following is a
1937 legal LLVM file:</p>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001938
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00001939<div class="doc_code">
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001940<pre>
Chris Lattnera18a4242007-06-06 18:28:13 +00001941@X = global i32 17
1942@Y = global i32 42
1943@Z = global [2 x i32*] [ i32* @X, i32* @Y ]
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001944</pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00001945</div>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001946
1947</div>
1948
1949<!-- ======================================================================= -->
Reid Spencer2dc45b82004-12-09 18:13:12 +00001950<div class="doc_subsection"><a name="undefvalues">Undefined Values</a></div>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001951<div class="doc_text">
1952
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001953<p>The string '<tt>undef</tt>' is recognized as a type-less constant that has no
1954 specific value. Undefined values may be of any type and be used anywhere a
1955 constant is permitted.</p>
1956
1957<p>Undefined values indicate to the compiler that the program is well defined no
1958 matter what value is used, giving the compiler more freedom to optimize.</p>
1959
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001960</div>
1961
1962<!-- ======================================================================= -->
1963<div class="doc_subsection"><a name="constantexprs">Constant Expressions</a>
1964</div>
1965
1966<div class="doc_text">
1967
1968<p>Constant expressions are used to allow expressions involving other constants
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001969 to be used as constants. Constant expressions may be of
1970 any <a href="#t_firstclass">first class</a> type and may involve any LLVM
1971 operation that does not have side effects (e.g. load and call are not
1972 supported). The following is the syntax for constant expressions:</p>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001973
1974<dl>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00001975 <dt><b><tt>trunc ( CST to TYPE )</tt></b></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001976 <dd>Truncate a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be larger
1977 than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.</dd>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00001978
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00001979 <dt><b><tt>zext ( CST to TYPE )</tt></b></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001980 <dd>Zero extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
1981 smaller or equal to the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be
1982 integers.</dd>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00001983
1984 <dt><b><tt>sext ( CST to TYPE )</tt></b></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001985 <dd>Sign extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
1986 smaller or equal to the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be
1987 integers.</dd>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00001988
1989 <dt><b><tt>fptrunc ( CST to TYPE )</tt></b></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001990 <dd>Truncate a floating point constant to another floating point type. The
1991 size of CST must be larger than the size of TYPE. Both types must be
1992 floating point.</dd>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00001993
1994 <dt><b><tt>fpext ( CST to TYPE )</tt></b></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00001995 <dd>Floating point extend a constant to another type. The size of CST must be
1996 smaller or equal to the size of TYPE. Both types must be floating
1997 point.</dd>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00001998
Reid Spencer1539a1c2007-07-31 14:40:14 +00001999 <dt><b><tt>fptoui ( CST to TYPE )</tt></b></dt>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00002000 <dd>Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding unsigned integer
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002001 constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST must be of
2002 scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE must be scalars,
2003 or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value won't fit in the
2004 integer type, the results are undefined.</dd>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00002005
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00002006 <dt><b><tt>fptosi ( CST to TYPE )</tt></b></dt>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00002007 <dd>Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding signed integer
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002008 constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST must be of
2009 scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE must be scalars,
2010 or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value won't fit in the
2011 integer type, the results are undefined.</dd>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00002012
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00002013 <dt><b><tt>uitofp ( CST to TYPE )</tt></b></dt>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00002014 <dd>Convert an unsigned integer constant to the corresponding floating point
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002015 constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type. CST must be
2016 of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must be scalars, or
2017 vectors of the same number of elements. If the value won't fit in the
2018 floating point type, the results are undefined.</dd>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00002019
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00002020 <dt><b><tt>sitofp ( CST to TYPE )</tt></b></dt>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00002021 <dd>Convert a signed integer constant to the corresponding floating point
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002022 constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type. CST must be
2023 of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must be scalars, or
2024 vectors of the same number of elements. If the value won't fit in the
2025 floating point type, the results are undefined.</dd>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00002026
Reid Spencer5c0ef472006-11-11 23:08:07 +00002027 <dt><b><tt>ptrtoint ( CST to TYPE )</tt></b></dt>
2028 <dd>Convert a pointer typed constant to the corresponding integer constant
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002029 <tt>TYPE</tt> must be an integer type. <tt>CST</tt> must be of pointer
2030 type. The <tt>CST</tt> value is zero extended, truncated, or unchanged to
2031 make it fit in <tt>TYPE</tt>.</dd>
Reid Spencer5c0ef472006-11-11 23:08:07 +00002032
2033 <dt><b><tt>inttoptr ( CST to TYPE )</tt></b></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002034 <dd>Convert a integer constant to a pointer constant. TYPE must be a pointer
2035 type. CST must be of integer type. The CST value is zero extended,
2036 truncated, or unchanged to make it fit in a pointer size. This one is
2037 <i>really</i> dangerous!</dd>
Reid Spencer5c0ef472006-11-11 23:08:07 +00002038
2039 <dt><b><tt>bitcast ( CST to TYPE )</tt></b></dt>
Chris Lattner03bbad62009-02-28 18:27:03 +00002040 <dd>Convert a constant, CST, to another TYPE. The constraints of the operands
2041 are the same as those for the <a href="#i_bitcast">bitcast
2042 instruction</a>.</dd>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002043
2044 <dt><b><tt>getelementptr ( CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ... )</tt></b></dt>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002045 <dd>Perform the <a href="#i_getelementptr">getelementptr operation</a> on
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002046 constants. As with the <a href="#i_getelementptr">getelementptr</a>
2047 instruction, the index list may have zero or more indexes, which are
2048 required to make sense for the type of "CSTPTR".</dd>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002049
Robert Bocchino9fbe1452006-01-10 19:31:34 +00002050 <dt><b><tt>select ( COND, VAL1, VAL2 )</tt></b></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002051 <dd>Perform the <a href="#i_select">select operation</a> on constants.</dd>
Reid Spencer01c42592006-12-04 19:23:19 +00002052
2053 <dt><b><tt>icmp COND ( VAL1, VAL2 )</tt></b></dt>
2054 <dd>Performs the <a href="#i_icmp">icmp operation</a> on constants.</dd>
2055
2056 <dt><b><tt>fcmp COND ( VAL1, VAL2 )</tt></b></dt>
2057 <dd>Performs the <a href="#i_fcmp">fcmp operation</a> on constants.</dd>
Robert Bocchino9fbe1452006-01-10 19:31:34 +00002058
2059 <dt><b><tt>extractelement ( VAL, IDX )</tt></b></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002060 <dd>Perform the <a href="#i_extractelement">extractelement operation</a> on
2061 constants.</dd>
Robert Bocchino9fbe1452006-01-10 19:31:34 +00002062
Robert Bocchino05ccd702006-01-15 20:48:27 +00002063 <dt><b><tt>insertelement ( VAL, ELT, IDX )</tt></b></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002064 <dd>Perform the <a href="#i_insertelement">insertelement operation</a> on
2065 constants.</dd>
Chris Lattnerc1989542006-04-08 00:13:41 +00002066
2067 <dt><b><tt>shufflevector ( VEC1, VEC2, IDXMASK )</tt></b></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002068 <dd>Perform the <a href="#i_shufflevector">shufflevector operation</a> on
2069 constants.</dd>
Chris Lattnerc1989542006-04-08 00:13:41 +00002070
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002071 <dt><b><tt>OPCODE ( LHS, RHS )</tt></b></dt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002072 <dd>Perform the specified operation of the LHS and RHS constants. OPCODE may
2073 be any of the <a href="#binaryops">binary</a>
2074 or <a href="#bitwiseops">bitwise binary</a> operations. The constraints
2075 on operands are the same as those for the corresponding instruction
2076 (e.g. no bitwise operations on floating point values are allowed).</dd>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002077</dl>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002078
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002079</div>
Chris Lattner9ee5d222004-03-08 16:49:10 +00002080
Nick Lewycky21cc4462009-04-04 07:22:01 +00002081<!-- ======================================================================= -->
2082<div class="doc_subsection"><a name="metadata">Embedded Metadata</a>
2083</div>
2084
2085<div class="doc_text">
2086
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002087<p>Embedded metadata provides a way to attach arbitrary data to the instruction
2088 stream without affecting the behaviour of the program. There are two
2089 metadata primitives, strings and nodes. All metadata has the
2090 <tt>metadata</tt> type and is identified in syntax by a preceding exclamation
2091 point ('<tt>!</tt>').</p>
Nick Lewycky21cc4462009-04-04 07:22:01 +00002092
2093<p>A metadata string is a string surrounded by double quotes. It can contain
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002094 any character by escaping non-printable characters with "\xx" where "xx" is
2095 the two digit hex code. For example: "<tt>!"test\00"</tt>".</p>
Nick Lewycky21cc4462009-04-04 07:22:01 +00002096
2097<p>Metadata nodes are represented with notation similar to structure constants
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002098 (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by braces and preceeded by an
2099 exclamation point). For example: "<tt>!{ metadata !"test\00", i32
2100 10}</tt>".</p>
Nick Lewycky21cc4462009-04-04 07:22:01 +00002101
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002102<p>A metadata node will attempt to track changes to the values it holds. In the
2103 event that a value is deleted, it will be replaced with a typeless
2104 "<tt>null</tt>", such as "<tt>metadata !{null, i32 10}</tt>".</p>
Nick Lewyckycb337992009-05-10 20:57:05 +00002105
Nick Lewycky21cc4462009-04-04 07:22:01 +00002106<p>Optimizations may rely on metadata to provide additional information about
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002107 the program that isn't available in the instructions, or that isn't easily
2108 computable. Similarly, the code generator may expect a certain metadata
2109 format to be used to express debugging information.</p>
2110
Nick Lewycky21cc4462009-04-04 07:22:01 +00002111</div>
2112
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002113<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002114<div class="doc_section"> <a name="othervalues">Other Values</a> </div>
2115<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
2116
2117<!-- ======================================================================= -->
2118<div class="doc_subsection">
2119<a name="inlineasm">Inline Assembler Expressions</a>
2120</div>
2121
2122<div class="doc_text">
2123
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002124<p>LLVM supports inline assembler expressions (as opposed
2125 to <a href="#moduleasm"> Module-Level Inline Assembly</a>) through the use of
2126 a special value. This value represents the inline assembler as a string
2127 (containing the instructions to emit), a list of operand constraints (stored
2128 as a string), and a flag that indicates whether or not the inline asm
2129 expression has side effects. An example inline assembler expression is:</p>
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002130
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00002131<div class="doc_code">
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002132<pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00002133i32 (i32) asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002134</pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00002135</div>
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002136
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002137<p>Inline assembler expressions may <b>only</b> be used as the callee operand of
2138 a <a href="#i_call"><tt>call</tt> instruction</a>. Thus, typically we
2139 have:</p>
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002140
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00002141<div class="doc_code">
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002142<pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00002143%X = call i32 asm "<a href="#int_bswap">bswap</a> $0", "=r,r"(i32 %Y)
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002144</pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00002145</div>
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002146
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002147<p>Inline asms with side effects not visible in the constraint list must be
2148 marked as having side effects. This is done through the use of the
2149 '<tt>sideeffect</tt>' keyword, like so:</p>
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002150
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00002151<div class="doc_code">
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002152<pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00002153call void asm sideeffect "eieio", ""()
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002154</pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00002155</div>
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002156
2157<p>TODO: The format of the asm and constraints string still need to be
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002158 documented here. Constraints on what can be done (e.g. duplication, moving,
2159 etc need to be documented). This is probably best done by reference to
2160 another document that covers inline asm from a holistic perspective.</p>
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002161
2162</div>
2163
Chris Lattner857755c2009-07-20 05:55:19 +00002164
2165<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
2166<div class="doc_section">
2167 <a name="intrinsic_globals">Intrinsic Global Variables</a>
2168</div>
2169<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
2170
2171<p>LLVM has a number of "magic" global variables that contain data that affect
2172code generation or other IR semantics. These are documented here. All globals
Chris Lattner401e10c2009-07-20 06:14:25 +00002173of this sort should have a section specified as "<tt>llvm.metadata</tt>". This
2174section and all globals that start with "<tt>llvm.</tt>" are reserved for use
2175by LLVM.</p>
Chris Lattner857755c2009-07-20 05:55:19 +00002176
2177<!-- ======================================================================= -->
2178<div class="doc_subsection">
2179<a name="intg_used">The '<tt>llvm.used</tt>' Global Variable</a>
2180</div>
2181
2182<div class="doc_text">
2183
2184<p>The <tt>@llvm.used</tt> global is an array with i8* element type which has <a
2185href="#linkage_appending">appending linkage</a>. This array contains a list of
2186pointers to global variables and functions which may optionally have a pointer
2187cast formed of bitcast or getelementptr. For example, a legal use of it is:</p>
2188
2189<pre>
2190 @X = global i8 4
2191 @Y = global i32 123
2192
2193 @llvm.used = appending global [2 x i8*] [
2194 i8* @X,
2195 i8* bitcast (i32* @Y to i8*)
2196 ], section "llvm.metadata"
2197</pre>
2198
2199<p>If a global variable appears in the <tt>@llvm.used</tt> list, then the
2200compiler, assembler, and linker are required to treat the symbol as if there is
2201a reference to the global that it cannot see. For example, if a variable has
2202internal linkage and no references other than that from the <tt>@llvm.used</tt>
2203list, it cannot be deleted. This is commonly used to represent references from
2204inline asms and other things the compiler cannot "see", and corresponds to
2205"attribute((used))" in GNU C.</p>
2206
2207<p>On some targets, the code generator must emit a directive to the assembler or
2208object file to prevent the assembler and linker from molesting the symbol.</p>
2209
2210</div>
2211
2212<!-- ======================================================================= -->
2213<div class="doc_subsection">
Chris Lattner401e10c2009-07-20 06:14:25 +00002214<a name="intg_compiler_used">The '<tt>llvm.compiler.used</tt>' Global Variable</a>
2215</div>
2216
2217<div class="doc_text">
2218
2219<p>The <tt>@llvm.compiler.used</tt> directive is the same as the
2220<tt>@llvm.used</tt> directive, except that it only prevents the compiler from
2221touching the symbol. On targets that support it, this allows an intelligent
2222linker to optimize references to the symbol without being impeded as it would be
2223by <tt>@llvm.used</tt>.</p>
2224
2225<p>This is a rare construct that should only be used in rare circumstances, and
2226should not be exposed to source languages.</p>
2227
2228</div>
2229
2230<!-- ======================================================================= -->
2231<div class="doc_subsection">
Chris Lattner857755c2009-07-20 05:55:19 +00002232<a name="intg_global_ctors">The '<tt>llvm.global_ctors</tt>' Global Variable</a>
2233</div>
2234
2235<div class="doc_text">
2236
2237<p>TODO: Describe this.</p>
2238
2239</div>
2240
2241<!-- ======================================================================= -->
2242<div class="doc_subsection">
2243<a name="intg_global_dtors">The '<tt>llvm.global_dtors</tt>' Global Variable</a>
2244</div>
2245
2246<div class="doc_text">
2247
2248<p>TODO: Describe this.</p>
2249
2250</div>
2251
2252
Chris Lattnere87d6532006-01-25 23:47:57 +00002253<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002254<div class="doc_section"> <a name="instref">Instruction Reference</a> </div>
2255<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002256
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002257<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002258
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002259<p>The LLVM instruction set consists of several different classifications of
2260 instructions: <a href="#terminators">terminator
2261 instructions</a>, <a href="#binaryops">binary instructions</a>,
2262 <a href="#bitwiseops">bitwise binary instructions</a>,
2263 <a href="#memoryops">memory instructions</a>, and
2264 <a href="#otherops">other instructions</a>.</p>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002265
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002266</div>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002267
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002268<!-- ======================================================================= -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002269<div class="doc_subsection"> <a name="terminators">Terminator
2270Instructions</a> </div>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002271
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002272<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002273
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002274<p>As mentioned <a href="#functionstructure">previously</a>, every basic block
2275 in a program ends with a "Terminator" instruction, which indicates which
2276 block should be executed after the current block is finished. These
2277 terminator instructions typically yield a '<tt>void</tt>' value: they produce
2278 control flow, not values (the one exception being the
2279 '<a href="#i_invoke"><tt>invoke</tt></a>' instruction).</p>
2280
2281<p>There are six different terminator instructions: the
2282 '<a href="#i_ret"><tt>ret</tt></a>' instruction, the
2283 '<a href="#i_br"><tt>br</tt></a>' instruction, the
2284 '<a href="#i_switch"><tt>switch</tt></a>' instruction, the
2285 '<a href="#i_invoke"><tt>invoke</tt></a>' instruction, the
2286 '<a href="#i_unwind"><tt>unwind</tt></a>' instruction, and the
2287 '<a href="#i_unreachable"><tt>unreachable</tt></a>' instruction.</p>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002288
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002289</div>
Chris Lattnerc3f59762004-12-09 17:30:23 +00002290
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002291<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002292<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_ret">'<tt>ret</tt>'
2293Instruction</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002294
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002295<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002296
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002297<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Dan Gohmanb1e6b962008-10-04 19:00:07 +00002298<pre>
2299 ret &lt;type&gt; &lt;value&gt; <i>; Return a value from a non-void function</i>
Chris Lattner7faa8832002-04-14 06:13:44 +00002300 ret void <i>; Return from void function</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002301</pre>
Chris Lattnerf4cde4e2008-04-23 04:59:35 +00002302
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002303<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002304<p>The '<tt>ret</tt>' instruction is used to return control flow (and optionally
2305 a value) from a function back to the caller.</p>
2306
2307<p>There are two forms of the '<tt>ret</tt>' instruction: one that returns a
2308 value and then causes control flow, and one that just causes control flow to
2309 occur.</p>
Chris Lattnerf4cde4e2008-04-23 04:59:35 +00002310
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002311<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002312<p>The '<tt>ret</tt>' instruction optionally accepts a single argument, the
2313 return value. The type of the return value must be a
2314 '<a href="#t_firstclass">first class</a>' type.</p>
Dan Gohmanb1e6b962008-10-04 19:00:07 +00002315
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002316<p>A function is not <a href="#wellformed">well formed</a> if it it has a
2317 non-void return type and contains a '<tt>ret</tt>' instruction with no return
2318 value or a return value with a type that does not match its type, or if it
2319 has a void return type and contains a '<tt>ret</tt>' instruction with a
2320 return value.</p>
Chris Lattnerf4cde4e2008-04-23 04:59:35 +00002321
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002322<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002323<p>When the '<tt>ret</tt>' instruction is executed, control flow returns back to
2324 the calling function's context. If the caller is a
2325 "<a href="#i_call"><tt>call</tt></a>" instruction, execution continues at the
2326 instruction after the call. If the caller was an
2327 "<a href="#i_invoke"><tt>invoke</tt></a>" instruction, execution continues at
2328 the beginning of the "normal" destination block. If the instruction returns
2329 a value, that value shall set the call or invoke instruction's return
2330 value.</p>
Chris Lattnerf4cde4e2008-04-23 04:59:35 +00002331
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002332<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattnerf4cde4e2008-04-23 04:59:35 +00002333<pre>
2334 ret i32 5 <i>; Return an integer value of 5</i>
Chris Lattner7faa8832002-04-14 06:13:44 +00002335 ret void <i>; Return from a void function</i>
Bill Wendling0a4bbbf2009-02-28 22:12:54 +00002336 ret { i32, i8 } { i32 4, i8 2 } <i>; Return a struct of values 4 and 2</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002337</pre>
Dan Gohmanf3e60bd2009-01-12 23:12:39 +00002338
Dan Gohmand8791e52009-01-24 15:58:40 +00002339<p>Note that the code generator does not yet fully support large
2340 return values. The specific sizes that are currently supported are
2341 dependent on the target. For integers, on 32-bit targets the limit
2342 is often 64 bits, and on 64-bit targets the limit is often 128 bits.
2343 For aggregate types, the current limits are dependent on the element
2344 types; for example targets are often limited to 2 total integer
2345 elements and 2 total floating-point elements.</p>
Dan Gohmanf3e60bd2009-01-12 23:12:39 +00002346
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002347</div>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002348<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002349<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_br">'<tt>br</tt>' Instruction</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002350
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002351<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002352
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002353<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002354<pre>
2355 br i1 &lt;cond&gt;, label &lt;iftrue&gt;, label &lt;iffalse&gt;<br> br label &lt;dest&gt; <i>; Unconditional branch</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002356</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002357
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002358<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002359<p>The '<tt>br</tt>' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to a
2360 different basic block in the current function. There are two forms of this
2361 instruction, corresponding to a conditional branch and an unconditional
2362 branch.</p>
2363
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002364<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002365<p>The conditional branch form of the '<tt>br</tt>' instruction takes a single
2366 '<tt>i1</tt>' value and two '<tt>label</tt>' values. The unconditional form
2367 of the '<tt>br</tt>' instruction takes a single '<tt>label</tt>' value as a
2368 target.</p>
2369
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002370<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Reid Spencerc78f3372007-01-12 03:35:51 +00002371<p>Upon execution of a conditional '<tt>br</tt>' instruction, the '<tt>i1</tt>'
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002372 argument is evaluated. If the value is <tt>true</tt>, control flows to the
2373 '<tt>iftrue</tt>' <tt>label</tt> argument. If "cond" is <tt>false</tt>,
2374 control flows to the '<tt>iffalse</tt>' <tt>label</tt> argument.</p>
2375
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002376<h5>Example:</h5>
Bill Wendlingc39e3e02009-07-20 02:39:26 +00002377<pre>
2378Test:
2379 %cond = <a href="#i_icmp">icmp</a> eq i32 %a, %b
2380 br i1 %cond, label %IfEqual, label %IfUnequal
2381IfEqual:
2382 <a href="#i_ret">ret</a> i32 1
2383IfUnequal:
2384 <a href="#i_ret">ret</a> i32 0
2385</pre>
2386
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002387</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002388
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002389<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattnerc88c17b2004-02-24 04:54:45 +00002390<div class="doc_subsubsection">
2391 <a name="i_switch">'<tt>switch</tt>' Instruction</a>
2392</div>
2393
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002394<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerc88c17b2004-02-24 04:54:45 +00002395
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002396<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattnerc88c17b2004-02-24 04:54:45 +00002397<pre>
2398 switch &lt;intty&gt; &lt;value&gt;, label &lt;defaultdest&gt; [ &lt;intty&gt; &lt;val&gt;, label &lt;dest&gt; ... ]
2399</pre>
2400
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002401<h5>Overview:</h5>
Chris Lattnerc88c17b2004-02-24 04:54:45 +00002402<p>The '<tt>switch</tt>' instruction is used to transfer control flow to one of
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002403 several different places. It is a generalization of the '<tt>br</tt>'
2404 instruction, allowing a branch to occur to one of many possible
2405 destinations.</p>
Chris Lattnerc88c17b2004-02-24 04:54:45 +00002406
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002407<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Chris Lattnerc88c17b2004-02-24 04:54:45 +00002408<p>The '<tt>switch</tt>' instruction uses three parameters: an integer
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002409 comparison value '<tt>value</tt>', a default '<tt>label</tt>' destination,
2410 and an array of pairs of comparison value constants and '<tt>label</tt>'s.
2411 The table is not allowed to contain duplicate constant entries.</p>
Chris Lattnerc88c17b2004-02-24 04:54:45 +00002412
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002413<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002414<p>The <tt>switch</tt> instruction specifies a table of values and
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002415 destinations. When the '<tt>switch</tt>' instruction is executed, this table
2416 is searched for the given value. If the value is found, control flow is
2417 transfered to the corresponding destination; otherwise, control flow is
2418 transfered to the default destination.</p>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002419
Chris Lattnerc88c17b2004-02-24 04:54:45 +00002420<h5>Implementation:</h5>
Chris Lattnerc88c17b2004-02-24 04:54:45 +00002421<p>Depending on properties of the target machine and the particular
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002422 <tt>switch</tt> instruction, this instruction may be code generated in
2423 different ways. For example, it could be generated as a series of chained
2424 conditional branches or with a lookup table.</p>
Chris Lattnerc88c17b2004-02-24 04:54:45 +00002425
2426<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattnerc88c17b2004-02-24 04:54:45 +00002427<pre>
2428 <i>; Emulate a conditional br instruction</i>
Reid Spencerc78f3372007-01-12 03:35:51 +00002429 %Val = <a href="#i_zext">zext</a> i1 %value to i32
Dan Gohman2a08c532009-01-04 23:44:43 +00002430 switch i32 %Val, label %truedest [ i32 0, label %falsedest ]
Chris Lattnerc88c17b2004-02-24 04:54:45 +00002431
2432 <i>; Emulate an unconditional br instruction</i>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00002433 switch i32 0, label %dest [ ]
Chris Lattnerc88c17b2004-02-24 04:54:45 +00002434
2435 <i>; Implement a jump table:</i>
Dan Gohman2a08c532009-01-04 23:44:43 +00002436 switch i32 %val, label %otherwise [ i32 0, label %onzero
2437 i32 1, label %onone
2438 i32 2, label %ontwo ]
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002439</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002440
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002441</div>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002442
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002443<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002444<div class="doc_subsubsection">
2445 <a name="i_invoke">'<tt>invoke</tt>' Instruction</a>
2446</div>
2447
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002448<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002449
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002450<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002451<pre>
Devang Patel307e8ab2008-10-07 17:48:33 +00002452 &lt;result&gt; = invoke [<a href="#callingconv">cconv</a>] [<a href="#paramattrs">ret attrs</a>] &lt;ptr to function ty&gt; &lt;function ptr val&gt;(&lt;function args&gt;) [<a href="#fnattrs">fn attrs</a>]
Chris Lattner76b8a332006-05-14 18:23:06 +00002453 to label &lt;normal label&gt; unwind label &lt;exception label&gt;
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002454</pre>
2455
Chris Lattner6536cfe2002-05-06 22:08:29 +00002456<h5>Overview:</h5>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002457<p>The '<tt>invoke</tt>' instruction causes control to transfer to a specified
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002458 function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the
2459 '<tt>normal</tt>' label or the '<tt>exception</tt>' label. If the callee
2460 function returns with the "<tt><a href="#i_ret">ret</a></tt>" instruction,
2461 control flow will return to the "normal" label. If the callee (or any
2462 indirect callees) returns with the "<a href="#i_unwind"><tt>unwind</tt></a>"
2463 instruction, control is interrupted and continued at the dynamically nearest
2464 "exception" label.</p>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002465
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002466<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002467<p>This instruction requires several arguments:</p>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002468
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002469<ol>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002470 <li>The optional "cconv" marker indicates which <a href="#callingconv">calling
2471 convention</a> the call should use. If none is specified, the call
2472 defaults to using C calling conventions.</li>
Devang Patelf642f472008-10-06 18:50:38 +00002473
2474 <li>The optional <a href="#paramattrs">Parameter Attributes</a> list for
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002475 return values. Only '<tt>zeroext</tt>', '<tt>signext</tt>', and
2476 '<tt>inreg</tt>' attributes are valid here.</li>
Devang Patelf642f472008-10-06 18:50:38 +00002477
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002478 <li>'<tt>ptr to function ty</tt>': shall be the signature of the pointer to
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002479 function value being invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function
2480 invocation, but indirect <tt>invoke</tt>s are just as possible, branching
2481 off an arbitrary pointer to function value.</li>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002482
2483 <li>'<tt>function ptr val</tt>': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002484 function to be invoked. </li>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002485
2486 <li>'<tt>function args</tt>': argument list whose types match the function
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002487 signature argument types. If the function signature indicates the
2488 function accepts a variable number of arguments, the extra arguments can
2489 be specified.</li>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002490
2491 <li>'<tt>normal label</tt>': the label reached when the called function
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002492 executes a '<tt><a href="#i_ret">ret</a></tt>' instruction. </li>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002493
2494 <li>'<tt>exception label</tt>': the label reached when a callee returns with
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002495 the <a href="#i_unwind"><tt>unwind</tt></a> instruction. </li>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002496
Devang Patel307e8ab2008-10-07 17:48:33 +00002497 <li>The optional <a href="#fnattrs">function attributes</a> list. Only
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002498 '<tt>noreturn</tt>', '<tt>nounwind</tt>', '<tt>readonly</tt>' and
2499 '<tt>readnone</tt>' attributes are valid here.</li>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002500</ol>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002501
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002502<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002503<p>This instruction is designed to operate as a standard
2504 '<tt><a href="#i_call">call</a></tt>' instruction in most regards. The
2505 primary difference is that it establishes an association with a label, which
2506 is used by the runtime library to unwind the stack.</p>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002507
2508<p>This instruction is used in languages with destructors to ensure that proper
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002509 cleanup is performed in the case of either a <tt>longjmp</tt> or a thrown
2510 exception. Additionally, this is important for implementation of
2511 '<tt>catch</tt>' clauses in high-level languages that support them.</p>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002512
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002513<p>For the purposes of the SSA form, the definition of the value returned by the
2514 '<tt>invoke</tt>' instruction is deemed to occur on the edge from the current
2515 block to the "normal" label. If the callee unwinds then no return value is
2516 available.</p>
Dan Gohmanf96a4992009-05-22 21:47:08 +00002517
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002518<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattnerbad10ee2005-05-06 22:57:40 +00002519<pre>
Nick Lewyckyd703f652008-03-16 07:18:12 +00002520 %retval = invoke i32 @Test(i32 15) to label %Continue
Jeff Cohen6f1cc772007-04-22 01:17:39 +00002521 unwind label %TestCleanup <i>; {i32}:retval set</i>
Nick Lewyckyd703f652008-03-16 07:18:12 +00002522 %retval = invoke <a href="#callingconv">coldcc</a> i32 %Testfnptr(i32 15) to label %Continue
Jeff Cohen6f1cc772007-04-22 01:17:39 +00002523 unwind label %TestCleanup <i>; {i32}:retval set</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002524</pre>
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +00002525
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002526</div>
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +00002527
Chris Lattner27f71f22003-09-03 00:41:47 +00002528<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +00002529
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002530<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_unwind">'<tt>unwind</tt>'
2531Instruction</a> </div>
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +00002532
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002533<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +00002534
Chris Lattner27f71f22003-09-03 00:41:47 +00002535<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +00002536<pre>
2537 unwind
2538</pre>
2539
Chris Lattner27f71f22003-09-03 00:41:47 +00002540<h5>Overview:</h5>
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +00002541<p>The '<tt>unwind</tt>' instruction unwinds the stack, continuing control flow
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002542 at the first callee in the dynamic call stack which used
2543 an <a href="#i_invoke"><tt>invoke</tt></a> instruction to perform the call.
2544 This is primarily used to implement exception handling.</p>
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +00002545
Chris Lattner27f71f22003-09-03 00:41:47 +00002546<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Chris Lattner72ed2002008-04-19 21:01:16 +00002547<p>The '<tt>unwind</tt>' instruction causes execution of the current function to
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002548 immediately halt. The dynamic call stack is then searched for the
2549 first <a href="#i_invoke"><tt>invoke</tt></a> instruction on the call stack.
2550 Once found, execution continues at the "exceptional" destination block
2551 specified by the <tt>invoke</tt> instruction. If there is no <tt>invoke</tt>
2552 instruction in the dynamic call chain, undefined behavior results.</p>
2553
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002554</div>
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +00002555
2556<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
2557
2558<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_unreachable">'<tt>unreachable</tt>'
2559Instruction</a> </div>
2560
2561<div class="doc_text">
2562
2563<h5>Syntax:</h5>
2564<pre>
2565 unreachable
2566</pre>
2567
2568<h5>Overview:</h5>
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +00002569<p>The '<tt>unreachable</tt>' instruction has no defined semantics. This
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002570 instruction is used to inform the optimizer that a particular portion of the
2571 code is not reachable. This can be used to indicate that the code after a
2572 no-return function cannot be reached, and other facts.</p>
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +00002573
2574<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +00002575<p>The '<tt>unreachable</tt>' instruction has no defined semantics.</p>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002576
Chris Lattner35eca582004-10-16 18:04:13 +00002577</div>
2578
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002579<!-- ======================================================================= -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002580<div class="doc_subsection"> <a name="binaryops">Binary Operations</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002581
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002582<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002583
2584<p>Binary operators are used to do most of the computation in a program. They
2585 require two operands of the same type, execute an operation on them, and
2586 produce a single value. The operands might represent multiple data, as is
2587 the case with the <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> data type. The result value
2588 has the same type as its operands.</p>
2589
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002590<p>There are several different binary operators:</p>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002591
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002592</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002593
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002594<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002595<div class="doc_subsubsection">
2596 <a name="i_add">'<tt>add</tt>' Instruction</a>
2597</div>
2598
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002599<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002600
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002601<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002602<pre>
Dan Gohmancbb38f22009-07-20 22:41:19 +00002603 &lt;result&gt; = add &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
2604 &lt;result&gt; = signed add &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
2605 &lt;result&gt; = unsigned add &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002606</pre>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002607
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002608<h5>Overview:</h5>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002609<p>The '<tt>add</tt>' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002610
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002611<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002612<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>add</tt>' instruction must
2613 be <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of
2614 integer values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002615
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002616<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002617<p>The value produced is the integer sum of the two operands.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002618
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002619<p>If the sum has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the mathematical
2620 result modulo 2<sup>n</sup>, where n is the bit width of the result.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002621
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002622<p>Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this instruction
2623 is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002624
Dan Gohmancbb38f22009-07-20 22:41:19 +00002625<p>If the <tt>signed</tt> and/or <tt>unsigned</tt> keywords are present,
2626 the behavior of the <tt>add</tt> is undefined if signed and/or unsigned
2627 overflow, respectively, occurs.</p>
2628
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002629<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002630<pre>
2631 &lt;result&gt; = add i32 4, %var <i>; yields {i32}:result = 4 + %var</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002632</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002633
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002634</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002635
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002636<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002637<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002638 <a name="i_fadd">'<tt>fadd</tt>' Instruction</a>
2639</div>
2640
2641<div class="doc_text">
2642
2643<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002644<pre>
2645 &lt;result&gt; = fadd &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
2646</pre>
2647
2648<h5>Overview:</h5>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002649<p>The '<tt>fadd</tt>' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.</p>
2650
2651<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002652<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>fadd</tt>' instruction must be
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002653 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of
2654 floating point values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002655
2656<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002657<p>The value produced is the floating point sum of the two operands.</p>
2658
2659<h5>Example:</h5>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002660<pre>
2661 &lt;result&gt; = fadd float 4.0, %var <i>; yields {float}:result = 4.0 + %var</i>
2662</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002663
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002664</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002665
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002666<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
2667<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002668 <a name="i_sub">'<tt>sub</tt>' Instruction</a>
2669</div>
2670
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002671<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002672
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002673<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002674<pre>
Dan Gohmancbb38f22009-07-20 22:41:19 +00002675 &lt;result&gt; = sub &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
2676 &lt;result&gt; = signed sub &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
2677 &lt;result&gt; = unsigned sub &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002678</pre>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002679
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002680<h5>Overview:</h5>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002681<p>The '<tt>sub</tt>' instruction returns the difference of its two
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002682 operands.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002683
2684<p>Note that the '<tt>sub</tt>' instruction is used to represent the
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002685 '<tt>neg</tt>' instruction present in most other intermediate
2686 representations.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002687
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002688<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002689<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>sub</tt>' instruction must
2690 be <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of
2691 integer values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002692
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002693<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002694<p>The value produced is the integer difference of the two operands.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002695
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002696<p>If the difference has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002697 mathematical result modulo 2<sup>n</sup>, where n is the bit width of the
2698 result.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002699
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002700<p>Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this instruction
2701 is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002702
Dan Gohmancbb38f22009-07-20 22:41:19 +00002703<p>If the <tt>signed</tt> and/or <tt>unsigned</tt> keywords are present,
2704 the behavior of the <tt>sub</tt> is undefined if signed and/or unsigned
2705 overflow, respectively, occurs.</p>
2706
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002707<h5>Example:</h5>
Bill Wendlingaac388b2007-05-29 09:42:13 +00002708<pre>
2709 &lt;result&gt; = sub i32 4, %var <i>; yields {i32}:result = 4 - %var</i>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00002710 &lt;result&gt; = sub i32 0, %val <i>; yields {i32}:result = -%var</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002711</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002712
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002713</div>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002714
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002715<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002716<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002717 <a name="i_fsub">'<tt>fsub</tt>' Instruction</a>
2718</div>
2719
2720<div class="doc_text">
2721
2722<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002723<pre>
2724 &lt;result&gt; = fsub &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
2725</pre>
2726
2727<h5>Overview:</h5>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002728<p>The '<tt>fsub</tt>' instruction returns the difference of its two
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002729 operands.</p>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002730
2731<p>Note that the '<tt>fsub</tt>' instruction is used to represent the
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002732 '<tt>fneg</tt>' instruction present in most other intermediate
2733 representations.</p>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002734
2735<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlingd9fe2982009-07-20 02:32:41 +00002736<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>fsub</tt>' instruction must be
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002737 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of
2738 floating point values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002739
2740<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002741<p>The value produced is the floating point difference of the two operands.</p>
2742
2743<h5>Example:</h5>
2744<pre>
2745 &lt;result&gt; = fsub float 4.0, %var <i>; yields {float}:result = 4.0 - %var</i>
2746 &lt;result&gt; = fsub float -0.0, %val <i>; yields {float}:result = -%var</i>
2747</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002748
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002749</div>
2750
2751<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
2752<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002753 <a name="i_mul">'<tt>mul</tt>' Instruction</a>
2754</div>
2755
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002756<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002757
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002758<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002759<pre>
Dan Gohmancbb38f22009-07-20 22:41:19 +00002760 &lt;result&gt; = mul &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
2761 &lt;result&gt; = signed mul &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
2762 &lt;result&gt; = unsigned mul &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002763</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002764
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002765<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002766<p>The '<tt>mul</tt>' instruction returns the product of its two operands.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002767
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002768<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002769<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>mul</tt>' instruction must
2770 be <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of
2771 integer values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002772
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002773<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002774<p>The value produced is the integer product of the two operands.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002775
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002776<p>If the result of the multiplication has unsigned overflow, the result
2777 returned is the mathematical result modulo 2<sup>n</sup>, where n is the bit
2778 width of the result.</p>
2779
2780<p>Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, and the result
2781 is the same width as the operands, this instruction returns the correct
2782 result for both signed and unsigned integers. If a full product
2783 (e.g. <tt>i32</tt>x<tt>i32</tt>-><tt>i64</tt>) is needed, the operands should
2784 be sign-extended or zero-extended as appropriate to the width of the full
2785 product.</p>
2786
Dan Gohmancbb38f22009-07-20 22:41:19 +00002787<p>If the <tt>signed</tt> and/or <tt>unsigned</tt> keywords are present,
2788 the behavior of the <tt>mul</tt> is undefined if signed and/or unsigned
2789 overflow, respectively, occurs.</p>
2790
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002791<h5>Example:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002792<pre>
2793 &lt;result&gt; = mul i32 4, %var <i>; yields {i32}:result = 4 * %var</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002794</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002795
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002796</div>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002797
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002798<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002799<div class="doc_subsubsection">
2800 <a name="i_fmul">'<tt>fmul</tt>' Instruction</a>
2801</div>
2802
2803<div class="doc_text">
2804
2805<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002806<pre>
2807 &lt;result&gt; = fmul &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002808</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002809
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002810<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002811<p>The '<tt>fmul</tt>' instruction returns the product of its two operands.</p>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002812
2813<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002814<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>fmul</tt>' instruction must be
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002815 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of
2816 floating point values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002817
2818<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002819<p>The value produced is the floating point product of the two operands.</p>
2820
2821<h5>Example:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002822<pre>
2823 &lt;result&gt; = fmul float 4.0, %var <i>; yields {float}:result = 4.0 * %var</i>
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002824</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002825
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002826</div>
2827
2828<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002829<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_udiv">'<tt>udiv</tt>' Instruction
2830</a></div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002831
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002832<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002833
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002834<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002835<pre>
2836 &lt;result&gt; = udiv &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002837</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002838
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002839<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002840<p>The '<tt>udiv</tt>' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002841
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002842<h5>Arguments:</h5>
2843<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>udiv</tt>' instruction must be
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002844 <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of integer
2845 values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002846
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002847<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Chris Lattner5ec89832008-01-28 00:36:27 +00002848<p>The value produced is the unsigned integer quotient of the two operands.</p>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002849
Chris Lattner5ec89832008-01-28 00:36:27 +00002850<p>Note that unsigned integer division and signed integer division are distinct
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002851 operations; for signed integer division, use '<tt>sdiv</tt>'.</p>
2852
Chris Lattner5ec89832008-01-28 00:36:27 +00002853<p>Division by zero leads to undefined behavior.</p>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002854
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002855<h5>Example:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002856<pre>
2857 &lt;result&gt; = udiv i32 4, %var <i>; yields {i32}:result = 4 / %var</i>
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002858</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002859
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002860</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002861
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002862<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
2863<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_sdiv">'<tt>sdiv</tt>' Instruction
2864</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002865
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002866<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002867
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002868<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002869<pre>
Dan Gohmancbb38f22009-07-20 22:41:19 +00002870 &lt;result&gt; = sdiv &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
2871 &lt;result&gt; = exact sdiv &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002872</pre>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002873
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002874<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002875<p>The '<tt>sdiv</tt>' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002876
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002877<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002878<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>sdiv</tt>' instruction must be
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002879 <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of integer
2880 values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002881
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002882<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002883<p>The value produced is the signed integer quotient of the two operands rounded
2884 towards zero.</p>
2885
Chris Lattner5ec89832008-01-28 00:36:27 +00002886<p>Note that signed integer division and unsigned integer division are distinct
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002887 operations; for unsigned integer division, use '<tt>udiv</tt>'.</p>
2888
Chris Lattner5ec89832008-01-28 00:36:27 +00002889<p>Division by zero leads to undefined behavior. Overflow also leads to
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002890 undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can occur, for example, by doing
2891 a 32-bit division of -2147483648 by -1.</p>
2892
Dan Gohmancbb38f22009-07-20 22:41:19 +00002893<p>If the <tt>exact</tt> keyword is present, the result of the <tt>sdiv</tt>
2894 is undefined if the result would be rounded or if overflow occurs.</p>
2895
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002896<h5>Example:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002897<pre>
2898 &lt;result&gt; = sdiv i32 4, %var <i>; yields {i32}:result = 4 / %var</i>
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002899</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002900
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002901</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002902
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002903<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
2904<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_fdiv">'<tt>fdiv</tt>'
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002905Instruction</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002906
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00002907<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002908
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00002909<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002910<pre>
Gabor Greiffb224a22008-08-07 21:46:00 +00002911 &lt;result&gt; = fdiv &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002912</pre>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002913
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002914<h5>Overview:</h5>
2915<p>The '<tt>fdiv</tt>' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002916
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002917<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Jeff Cohen6f1cc772007-04-22 01:17:39 +00002918<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>fdiv</tt>' instruction must be
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002919 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of
2920 floating point values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002921
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002922<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002923<p>The value produced is the floating point quotient of the two operands.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002924
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002925<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002926<pre>
2927 &lt;result&gt; = fdiv float 4.0, %var <i>; yields {float}:result = 4.0 / %var</i>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002928</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002929
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002930</div>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002931
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002932<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002933<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_urem">'<tt>urem</tt>' Instruction</a>
2934</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002935
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002936<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002937
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002938<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002939<pre>
2940 &lt;result&gt; = urem &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002941</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002942
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002943<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002944<p>The '<tt>urem</tt>' instruction returns the remainder from the unsigned
2945 division of its two arguments.</p>
2946
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002947<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002948<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>urem</tt>' instruction must be
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002949 <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of integer
2950 values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
2951
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002952<h5>Semantics:</h5>
2953<p>This instruction returns the unsigned integer <i>remainder</i> of a division.
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002954 This instruction always performs an unsigned division to get the
2955 remainder.</p>
2956
Chris Lattner5ec89832008-01-28 00:36:27 +00002957<p>Note that unsigned integer remainder and signed integer remainder are
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002958 distinct operations; for signed integer remainder, use '<tt>srem</tt>'.</p>
2959
Chris Lattner5ec89832008-01-28 00:36:27 +00002960<p>Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior.</p>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002961
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002962<h5>Example:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002963<pre>
2964 &lt;result&gt; = urem i32 4, %var <i>; yields {i32}:result = 4 % %var</i>
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002965</pre>
2966
2967</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002968
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002969<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002970<div class="doc_subsubsection">
2971 <a name="i_srem">'<tt>srem</tt>' Instruction</a>
2972</div>
2973
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002974<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002975
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002976<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002977<pre>
Gabor Greiffb224a22008-08-07 21:46:00 +00002978 &lt;result&gt; = srem &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002979</pre>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002980
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002981<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002982<p>The '<tt>srem</tt>' instruction returns the remainder from the signed
2983 division of its two operands. This instruction can also take
2984 <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> versions of the values in which case the
2985 elements must be integers.</p>
Chris Lattnerc7d3ab32008-01-04 04:33:49 +00002986
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002987<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002988<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>srem</tt>' instruction must be
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002989 <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of integer
2990 values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00002991
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00002992<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002993<p>This instruction returns the <i>remainder</i> of a division (where the result
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00002994 has the same sign as the dividend, <tt>op1</tt>), not the <i>modulo</i>
2995 operator (where the result has the same sign as the divisor, <tt>op2</tt>) of
2996 a value. For more information about the difference,
2997 see <a href="http://mathforum.org/dr.math/problems/anne.4.28.99.html">The
2998 Math Forum</a>. For a table of how this is implemented in various languages,
2999 please see <a href="http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Modulo_operation">
3000 Wikipedia: modulo operation</a>.</p>
3001
Chris Lattner5ec89832008-01-28 00:36:27 +00003002<p>Note that signed integer remainder and unsigned integer remainder are
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003003 distinct operations; for unsigned integer remainder, use '<tt>urem</tt>'.</p>
3004
Chris Lattner5ec89832008-01-28 00:36:27 +00003005<p>Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003006 Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
3007 occur, for example, by taking the remainder of a 32-bit division of
3008 -2147483648 by -1. (The remainder doesn't actually overflow, but this rule
3009 lets srem be implemented using instructions that return both the result of
3010 the division and the remainder.)</p>
3011
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00003012<h5>Example:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003013<pre>
3014 &lt;result&gt; = srem i32 4, %var <i>; yields {i32}:result = 4 % %var</i>
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003015</pre>
3016
3017</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003018
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003019<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003020<div class="doc_subsubsection">
3021 <a name="i_frem">'<tt>frem</tt>' Instruction</a> </div>
3022
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003023<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003024
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003025<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003026<pre>
3027 &lt;result&gt; = frem &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003028</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003029
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003030<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003031<p>The '<tt>frem</tt>' instruction returns the remainder from the division of
3032 its two operands.</p>
3033
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003034<h5>Arguments:</h5>
3035<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>frem</tt>' instruction must be
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003036 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of
3037 floating point values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003038
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003039<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003040<p>This instruction returns the <i>remainder</i> of a division. The remainder
3041 has the same sign as the dividend.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003042
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003043<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003044<pre>
3045 &lt;result&gt; = frem float 4.0, %var <i>; yields {float}:result = 4.0 % %var</i>
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00003046</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003047
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003048</div>
Robert Bocchino7b81c752006-02-17 21:18:08 +00003049
Reid Spencer8e11bf82007-02-02 13:57:07 +00003050<!-- ======================================================================= -->
3051<div class="doc_subsection"> <a name="bitwiseops">Bitwise Binary
3052Operations</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003053
Reid Spencer8e11bf82007-02-02 13:57:07 +00003054<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003055
3056<p>Bitwise binary operators are used to do various forms of bit-twiddling in a
3057 program. They are generally very efficient instructions and can commonly be
3058 strength reduced from other instructions. They require two operands of the
3059 same type, execute an operation on them, and produce a single value. The
3060 resulting value is the same type as its operands.</p>
3061
Reid Spencer8e11bf82007-02-02 13:57:07 +00003062</div>
3063
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003064<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
3065<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_shl">'<tt>shl</tt>'
3066Instruction</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003067
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003068<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003069
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003070<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003071<pre>
3072 &lt;result&gt; = shl &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003073</pre>
Chris Lattner6ccc2d52007-10-03 21:01:14 +00003074
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003075<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003076<p>The '<tt>shl</tt>' instruction returns the first operand shifted to the left
3077 a specified number of bits.</p>
Chris Lattner6ccc2d52007-10-03 21:01:14 +00003078
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003079<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003080<p>Both arguments to the '<tt>shl</tt>' instruction must be the
3081 same <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of
3082 integer type. '<tt>op2</tt>' is treated as an unsigned value.</p>
Chris Lattner6ccc2d52007-10-03 21:01:14 +00003083
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003084<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003085<p>The value produced is <tt>op1</tt> * 2<sup><tt>op2</tt></sup> mod
3086 2<sup>n</sup>, where <tt>n</tt> is the width of the result. If <tt>op2</tt>
3087 is (statically or dynamically) negative or equal to or larger than the number
3088 of bits in <tt>op1</tt>, the result is undefined. If the arguments are
3089 vectors, each vector element of <tt>op1</tt> is shifted by the corresponding
3090 shift amount in <tt>op2</tt>.</p>
Chris Lattner6ccc2d52007-10-03 21:01:14 +00003091
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003092<h5>Example:</h5>
3093<pre>
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003094 &lt;result&gt; = shl i32 4, %var <i>; yields {i32}: 4 &lt;&lt; %var</i>
3095 &lt;result&gt; = shl i32 4, 2 <i>; yields {i32}: 16</i>
3096 &lt;result&gt; = shl i32 1, 10 <i>; yields {i32}: 1024</i>
Chris Lattner6ccc2d52007-10-03 21:01:14 +00003097 &lt;result&gt; = shl i32 1, 32 <i>; undefined</i>
Mon P Wange9f10152008-12-09 05:46:39 +00003098 &lt;result&gt; = shl &lt;2 x i32&gt; &lt; i32 1, i32 1&gt;, &lt; i32 1, i32 2&gt; <i>; yields: result=&lt;2 x i32&gt; &lt; i32 2, i32 4&gt;</i>
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003099</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003100
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003101</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003102
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003103<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
3104<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_lshr">'<tt>lshr</tt>'
3105Instruction</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003106
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003107<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003108
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003109<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003110<pre>
3111 &lt;result&gt; = lshr &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003112</pre>
3113
3114<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003115<p>The '<tt>lshr</tt>' instruction (logical shift right) returns the first
3116 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with zero fill.</p>
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003117
3118<h5>Arguments:</h5>
3119<p>Both arguments to the '<tt>lshr</tt>' instruction must be the same
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003120 <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of integer
3121 type. '<tt>op2</tt>' is treated as an unsigned value.</p>
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003122
3123<h5>Semantics:</h5>
3124<p>This instruction always performs a logical shift right operation. The most
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003125 significant bits of the result will be filled with zero bits after the shift.
3126 If <tt>op2</tt> is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger than the
3127 number of bits in <tt>op1</tt>, the result is undefined. If the arguments are
3128 vectors, each vector element of <tt>op1</tt> is shifted by the corresponding
3129 shift amount in <tt>op2</tt>.</p>
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003130
3131<h5>Example:</h5>
3132<pre>
3133 &lt;result&gt; = lshr i32 4, 1 <i>; yields {i32}:result = 2</i>
3134 &lt;result&gt; = lshr i32 4, 2 <i>; yields {i32}:result = 1</i>
3135 &lt;result&gt; = lshr i8 4, 3 <i>; yields {i8}:result = 0</i>
3136 &lt;result&gt; = lshr i8 -2, 1 <i>; yields {i8}:result = 0x7FFFFFFF </i>
Chris Lattner6ccc2d52007-10-03 21:01:14 +00003137 &lt;result&gt; = lshr i32 1, 32 <i>; undefined</i>
Mon P Wange9f10152008-12-09 05:46:39 +00003138 &lt;result&gt; = lshr &lt;2 x i32&gt; &lt; i32 -2, i32 4&gt;, &lt; i32 1, i32 2&gt; <i>; yields: result=&lt;2 x i32&gt; &lt; i32 0x7FFFFFFF, i32 1&gt;</i>
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003139</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003140
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003141</div>
3142
Reid Spencer8e11bf82007-02-02 13:57:07 +00003143<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003144<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_ashr">'<tt>ashr</tt>'
3145Instruction</a> </div>
3146<div class="doc_text">
3147
3148<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003149<pre>
3150 &lt;result&gt; = ashr &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003151</pre>
3152
3153<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003154<p>The '<tt>ashr</tt>' instruction (arithmetic shift right) returns the first
3155 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with sign
3156 extension.</p>
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003157
3158<h5>Arguments:</h5>
3159<p>Both arguments to the '<tt>ashr</tt>' instruction must be the same
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003160 <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of integer
3161 type. '<tt>op2</tt>' is treated as an unsigned value.</p>
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003162
3163<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003164<p>This instruction always performs an arithmetic shift right operation, The
3165 most significant bits of the result will be filled with the sign bit
3166 of <tt>op1</tt>. If <tt>op2</tt> is (statically or dynamically) equal to or
3167 larger than the number of bits in <tt>op1</tt>, the result is undefined. If
3168 the arguments are vectors, each vector element of <tt>op1</tt> is shifted by
3169 the corresponding shift amount in <tt>op2</tt>.</p>
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003170
3171<h5>Example:</h5>
3172<pre>
3173 &lt;result&gt; = ashr i32 4, 1 <i>; yields {i32}:result = 2</i>
3174 &lt;result&gt; = ashr i32 4, 2 <i>; yields {i32}:result = 1</i>
3175 &lt;result&gt; = ashr i8 4, 3 <i>; yields {i8}:result = 0</i>
3176 &lt;result&gt; = ashr i8 -2, 1 <i>; yields {i8}:result = -1</i>
Chris Lattner6ccc2d52007-10-03 21:01:14 +00003177 &lt;result&gt; = ashr i32 1, 32 <i>; undefined</i>
Mon P Wange9f10152008-12-09 05:46:39 +00003178 &lt;result&gt; = ashr &lt;2 x i32&gt; &lt; i32 -2, i32 4&gt;, &lt; i32 1, i32 3&gt; <i>; yields: result=&lt;2 x i32&gt; &lt; i32 -1, i32 0&gt;</i>
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003179</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003180
Reid Spencer569f2fa2007-01-31 21:39:12 +00003181</div>
3182
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003183<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00003184<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_and">'<tt>and</tt>'
3185Instruction</a> </div>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003186
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003187<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003188
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003189<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003190<pre>
Gabor Greiffb224a22008-08-07 21:46:00 +00003191 &lt;result&gt; = and &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003192</pre>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003193
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003194<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003195<p>The '<tt>and</tt>' instruction returns the bitwise logical and of its two
3196 operands.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003197
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003198<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003199<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>and</tt>' instruction must be
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003200 <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of integer
3201 values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003202
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003203<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003204<p>The truth table used for the '<tt>and</tt>' instruction is:</p>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003205
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003206<table border="1" cellspacing="0" cellpadding="4">
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00003207 <tbody>
3208 <tr>
3209 <td>In0</td>
3210 <td>In1</td>
3211 <td>Out</td>
3212 </tr>
3213 <tr>
3214 <td>0</td>
3215 <td>0</td>
3216 <td>0</td>
3217 </tr>
3218 <tr>
3219 <td>0</td>
3220 <td>1</td>
3221 <td>0</td>
3222 </tr>
3223 <tr>
3224 <td>1</td>
3225 <td>0</td>
3226 <td>0</td>
3227 </tr>
3228 <tr>
3229 <td>1</td>
3230 <td>1</td>
3231 <td>1</td>
3232 </tr>
3233 </tbody>
3234</table>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003235
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003236<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003237<pre>
3238 &lt;result&gt; = and i32 4, %var <i>; yields {i32}:result = 4 &amp; %var</i>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003239 &lt;result&gt; = and i32 15, 40 <i>; yields {i32}:result = 8</i>
3240 &lt;result&gt; = and i32 4, 8 <i>; yields {i32}:result = 0</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003241</pre>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003242</div>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003243<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00003244<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_or">'<tt>or</tt>' Instruction</a> </div>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003245
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003246<div class="doc_text">
3247
3248<h5>Syntax:</h5>
3249<pre>
3250 &lt;result&gt; = or &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
3251</pre>
3252
3253<h5>Overview:</h5>
3254<p>The '<tt>or</tt>' instruction returns the bitwise logical inclusive or of its
3255 two operands.</p>
3256
3257<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003258<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>or</tt>' instruction must be
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003259 <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of integer
3260 values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
3261
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003262<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003263<p>The truth table used for the '<tt>or</tt>' instruction is:</p>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003264
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00003265<table border="1" cellspacing="0" cellpadding="4">
3266 <tbody>
3267 <tr>
3268 <td>In0</td>
3269 <td>In1</td>
3270 <td>Out</td>
3271 </tr>
3272 <tr>
3273 <td>0</td>
3274 <td>0</td>
3275 <td>0</td>
3276 </tr>
3277 <tr>
3278 <td>0</td>
3279 <td>1</td>
3280 <td>1</td>
3281 </tr>
3282 <tr>
3283 <td>1</td>
3284 <td>0</td>
3285 <td>1</td>
3286 </tr>
3287 <tr>
3288 <td>1</td>
3289 <td>1</td>
3290 <td>1</td>
3291 </tr>
3292 </tbody>
3293</table>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003294
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003295<h5>Example:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003296<pre>
3297 &lt;result&gt; = or i32 4, %var <i>; yields {i32}:result = 4 | %var</i>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003298 &lt;result&gt; = or i32 15, 40 <i>; yields {i32}:result = 47</i>
3299 &lt;result&gt; = or i32 4, 8 <i>; yields {i32}:result = 12</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003300</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003301
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003302</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003303
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003304<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00003305<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_xor">'<tt>xor</tt>'
3306Instruction</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003307
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003308<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003309
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003310<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003311<pre>
3312 &lt;result&gt; = xor &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {ty}:result</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003313</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003314
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003315<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003316<p>The '<tt>xor</tt>' instruction returns the bitwise logical exclusive or of
3317 its two operands. The <tt>xor</tt> is used to implement the "one's
3318 complement" operation, which is the "~" operator in C.</p>
3319
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003320<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003321<p>The two arguments to the '<tt>xor</tt>' instruction must be
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003322 <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of integer
3323 values. Both arguments must have identical types.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00003324
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003325<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003326<p>The truth table used for the '<tt>xor</tt>' instruction is:</p>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003327
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00003328<table border="1" cellspacing="0" cellpadding="4">
3329 <tbody>
3330 <tr>
3331 <td>In0</td>
3332 <td>In1</td>
3333 <td>Out</td>
3334 </tr>
3335 <tr>
3336 <td>0</td>
3337 <td>0</td>
3338 <td>0</td>
3339 </tr>
3340 <tr>
3341 <td>0</td>
3342 <td>1</td>
3343 <td>1</td>
3344 </tr>
3345 <tr>
3346 <td>1</td>
3347 <td>0</td>
3348 <td>1</td>
3349 </tr>
3350 <tr>
3351 <td>1</td>
3352 <td>1</td>
3353 <td>0</td>
3354 </tr>
3355 </tbody>
3356</table>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003357
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003358<h5>Example:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003359<pre>
3360 &lt;result&gt; = xor i32 4, %var <i>; yields {i32}:result = 4 ^ %var</i>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003361 &lt;result&gt; = xor i32 15, 40 <i>; yields {i32}:result = 39</i>
3362 &lt;result&gt; = xor i32 4, 8 <i>; yields {i32}:result = 12</i>
3363 &lt;result&gt; = xor i32 %V, -1 <i>; yields {i32}:result = ~%V</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003364</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003365
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003366</div>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003367
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003368<!-- ======================================================================= -->
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003369<div class="doc_subsection">
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003370 <a name="vectorops">Vector Operations</a>
3371</div>
3372
3373<div class="doc_text">
3374
3375<p>LLVM supports several instructions to represent vector operations in a
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003376 target-independent manner. These instructions cover the element-access and
3377 vector-specific operations needed to process vectors effectively. While LLVM
3378 does directly support these vector operations, many sophisticated algorithms
3379 will want to use target-specific intrinsics to take full advantage of a
3380 specific target.</p>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003381
3382</div>
3383
3384<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
3385<div class="doc_subsubsection">
3386 <a name="i_extractelement">'<tt>extractelement</tt>' Instruction</a>
3387</div>
3388
3389<div class="doc_text">
3390
3391<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003392<pre>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003393 &lt;result&gt; = extractelement &lt;n x &lt;ty&gt;&gt; &lt;val&gt;, i32 &lt;idx&gt; <i>; yields &lt;ty&gt;</i>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003394</pre>
3395
3396<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003397<p>The '<tt>extractelement</tt>' instruction extracts a single scalar element
3398 from a vector at a specified index.</p>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003399
3400
3401<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003402<p>The first operand of an '<tt>extractelement</tt>' instruction is a value
3403 of <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> type. The second operand is an index
3404 indicating the position from which to extract the element. The index may be
3405 a variable.</p>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003406
3407<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003408<p>The result is a scalar of the same type as the element type of
3409 <tt>val</tt>. Its value is the value at position <tt>idx</tt> of
3410 <tt>val</tt>. If <tt>idx</tt> exceeds the length of <tt>val</tt>, the
3411 results are undefined.</p>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003412
3413<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003414<pre>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003415 %result = extractelement &lt;4 x i32&gt; %vec, i32 0 <i>; yields i32</i>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003416</pre>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003417
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003418</div>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003419
3420<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
3421<div class="doc_subsubsection">
3422 <a name="i_insertelement">'<tt>insertelement</tt>' Instruction</a>
3423</div>
3424
3425<div class="doc_text">
3426
3427<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003428<pre>
Dan Gohmanf3480b92008-05-12 23:38:42 +00003429 &lt;result&gt; = insertelement &lt;n x &lt;ty&gt;&gt; &lt;val&gt;, &lt;ty&gt; &lt;elt&gt;, i32 &lt;idx&gt; <i>; yields &lt;n x &lt;ty&gt;&gt;</i>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003430</pre>
3431
3432<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003433<p>The '<tt>insertelement</tt>' instruction inserts a scalar element into a
3434 vector at a specified index.</p>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003435
3436<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003437<p>The first operand of an '<tt>insertelement</tt>' instruction is a value
3438 of <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> type. The second operand is a scalar value
3439 whose type must equal the element type of the first operand. The third
3440 operand is an index indicating the position at which to insert the value.
3441 The index may be a variable.</p>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003442
3443<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003444<p>The result is a vector of the same type as <tt>val</tt>. Its element values
3445 are those of <tt>val</tt> except at position <tt>idx</tt>, where it gets the
3446 value <tt>elt</tt>. If <tt>idx</tt> exceeds the length of <tt>val</tt>, the
3447 results are undefined.</p>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003448
3449<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003450<pre>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003451 %result = insertelement &lt;4 x i32&gt; %vec, i32 1, i32 0 <i>; yields &lt;4 x i32&gt;</i>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003452</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003453
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003454</div>
3455
3456<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
3457<div class="doc_subsubsection">
3458 <a name="i_shufflevector">'<tt>shufflevector</tt>' Instruction</a>
3459</div>
3460
3461<div class="doc_text">
3462
3463<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003464<pre>
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00003465 &lt;result&gt; = shufflevector &lt;n x &lt;ty&gt;&gt; &lt;v1&gt;, &lt;n x &lt;ty&gt;&gt; &lt;v2&gt;, &lt;m x i32&gt; &lt;mask&gt; <i>; yields &lt;m x &lt;ty&gt;&gt;</i>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003466</pre>
3467
3468<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003469<p>The '<tt>shufflevector</tt>' instruction constructs a permutation of elements
3470 from two input vectors, returning a vector with the same element type as the
3471 input and length that is the same as the shuffle mask.</p>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003472
3473<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003474<p>The first two operands of a '<tt>shufflevector</tt>' instruction are vectors
3475 with types that match each other. The third argument is a shuffle mask whose
3476 element type is always 'i32'. The result of the instruction is a vector
3477 whose length is the same as the shuffle mask and whose element type is the
3478 same as the element type of the first two operands.</p>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003479
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003480<p>The shuffle mask operand is required to be a constant vector with either
3481 constant integer or undef values.</p>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003482
3483<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003484<p>The elements of the two input vectors are numbered from left to right across
3485 both of the vectors. The shuffle mask operand specifies, for each element of
3486 the result vector, which element of the two input vectors the result element
3487 gets. The element selector may be undef (meaning "don't care") and the
3488 second operand may be undef if performing a shuffle from only one vector.</p>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003489
3490<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003491<pre>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003492 %result = shufflevector &lt;4 x i32&gt; %v1, &lt;4 x i32&gt; %v2,
Jeff Cohen6f1cc772007-04-22 01:17:39 +00003493 &lt;4 x i32&gt; &lt;i32 0, i32 4, i32 1, i32 5&gt; <i>; yields &lt;4 x i32&gt;</i>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003494 %result = shufflevector &lt;4 x i32&gt; %v1, &lt;4 x i32&gt; undef,
3495 &lt;4 x i32&gt; &lt;i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3&gt; <i>; yields &lt;4 x i32&gt;</i> - Identity shuffle.
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00003496 %result = shufflevector &lt;8 x i32&gt; %v1, &lt;8 x i32&gt; undef,
3497 &lt;4 x i32&gt; &lt;i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3&gt; <i>; yields &lt;4 x i32&gt;</i>
3498 %result = shufflevector &lt;4 x i32&gt; %v1, &lt;4 x i32&gt; %v2,
3499 &lt;8 x i32&gt; &lt;i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3, i32 4, i32 5, i32 6, i32 7 &gt; <i>; yields &lt;8 x i32&gt;</i>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003500</pre>
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003501
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003502</div>
Tanya Lattner09474292006-04-14 19:24:33 +00003503
Chris Lattner3df241e2006-04-08 23:07:04 +00003504<!-- ======================================================================= -->
3505<div class="doc_subsection">
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003506 <a name="aggregateops">Aggregate Operations</a>
3507</div>
3508
3509<div class="doc_text">
3510
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003511<p>LLVM supports several instructions for working with aggregate values.</p>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003512
3513</div>
3514
3515<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
3516<div class="doc_subsubsection">
3517 <a name="i_extractvalue">'<tt>extractvalue</tt>' Instruction</a>
3518</div>
3519
3520<div class="doc_text">
3521
3522<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003523<pre>
3524 &lt;result&gt; = extractvalue &lt;aggregate type&gt; &lt;val&gt;, &lt;idx&gt;{, &lt;idx&gt;}*
3525</pre>
3526
3527<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003528<p>The '<tt>extractvalue</tt>' instruction extracts the value of a struct field
3529 or array element from an aggregate value.</p>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003530
3531<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003532<p>The first operand of an '<tt>extractvalue</tt>' instruction is a value
3533 of <a href="#t_struct">struct</a> or <a href="#t_array">array</a> type. The
3534 operands are constant indices to specify which value to extract in a similar
3535 manner as indices in a
3536 '<tt><a href="#i_getelementptr">getelementptr</a></tt>' instruction.</p>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003537
3538<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003539<p>The result is the value at the position in the aggregate specified by the
3540 index operands.</p>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003541
3542<h5>Example:</h5>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003543<pre>
Dan Gohman81a0c0b2008-05-31 00:58:22 +00003544 %result = extractvalue {i32, float} %agg, 0 <i>; yields i32</i>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003545</pre>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003546
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003547</div>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003548
3549<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
3550<div class="doc_subsubsection">
3551 <a name="i_insertvalue">'<tt>insertvalue</tt>' Instruction</a>
3552</div>
3553
3554<div class="doc_text">
3555
3556<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003557<pre>
Dan Gohman81a0c0b2008-05-31 00:58:22 +00003558 &lt;result&gt; = insertvalue &lt;aggregate type&gt; &lt;val&gt;, &lt;ty&gt; &lt;val&gt;, &lt;idx&gt; <i>; yields &lt;n x &lt;ty&gt;&gt;</i>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003559</pre>
3560
3561<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003562<p>The '<tt>insertvalue</tt>' instruction inserts a value into a struct field or
3563 array element in an aggregate.</p>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003564
3565
3566<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003567<p>The first operand of an '<tt>insertvalue</tt>' instruction is a value
3568 of <a href="#t_struct">struct</a> or <a href="#t_array">array</a> type. The
3569 second operand is a first-class value to insert. The following operands are
3570 constant indices indicating the position at which to insert the value in a
3571 similar manner as indices in a
3572 '<tt><a href="#i_getelementptr">getelementptr</a></tt>' instruction. The
3573 value to insert must have the same type as the value identified by the
3574 indices.</p>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003575
3576<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003577<p>The result is an aggregate of the same type as <tt>val</tt>. Its value is
3578 that of <tt>val</tt> except that the value at the position specified by the
3579 indices is that of <tt>elt</tt>.</p>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003580
3581<h5>Example:</h5>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003582<pre>
Dan Gohman52bb2db2008-06-23 15:26:37 +00003583 %result = insertvalue {i32, float} %agg, i32 1, 0 <i>; yields {i32, float}</i>
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003584</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003585
Dan Gohmana334d5f2008-05-12 23:51:09 +00003586</div>
3587
3588
3589<!-- ======================================================================= -->
3590<div class="doc_subsection">
Chris Lattner884a9702006-08-15 00:45:58 +00003591 <a name="memoryops">Memory Access and Addressing Operations</a>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003592</div>
3593
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003594<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003595
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003596<p>A key design point of an SSA-based representation is how it represents
3597 memory. In LLVM, no memory locations are in SSA form, which makes things
3598 very simple. This section describes how to read, write, allocate, and free
3599 memory in LLVM.</p>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003600
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003601</div>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003602
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003603<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003604<div class="doc_subsubsection">
3605 <a name="i_malloc">'<tt>malloc</tt>' Instruction</a>
3606</div>
3607
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003608<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003609
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003610<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003611<pre>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003612 &lt;result&gt; = malloc &lt;type&gt;[, i32 &lt;NumElements&gt;][, align &lt;alignment&gt;] <i>; yields {type*}:result</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003613</pre>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003614
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003615<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003616<p>The '<tt>malloc</tt>' instruction allocates memory from the system heap and
3617 returns a pointer to it. The object is always allocated in the generic
3618 address space (address space zero).</p>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003619
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003620<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003621<p>The '<tt>malloc</tt>' instruction allocates
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003622 <tt>sizeof(&lt;type&gt;)*NumElements</tt> bytes of memory from the operating
3623 system and returns a pointer of the appropriate type to the program. If
3624 "NumElements" is specified, it is the number of elements allocated, otherwise
3625 "NumElements" is defaulted to be one. If a constant alignment is specified,
3626 the value result of the allocation is guaranteed to be aligned to at least
3627 that boundary. If not specified, or if zero, the target can choose to align
3628 the allocation on any convenient boundary compatible with the type.</p>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003629
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003630<p>'<tt>type</tt>' must be a sized type.</p>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003631
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003632<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003633<p>Memory is allocated using the system "<tt>malloc</tt>" function, and a
3634 pointer is returned. The result of a zero byte allocation is undefined. The
3635 result is null if there is insufficient memory available.</p>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003636
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003637<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003638<pre>
Dan Gohman81e21672009-01-04 23:49:44 +00003639 %array = malloc [4 x i8] <i>; yields {[%4 x i8]*}:array</i>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003640
Bill Wendlingaac388b2007-05-29 09:42:13 +00003641 %size = <a href="#i_add">add</a> i32 2, 2 <i>; yields {i32}:size = i32 4</i>
3642 %array1 = malloc i8, i32 4 <i>; yields {i8*}:array1</i>
3643 %array2 = malloc [12 x i8], i32 %size <i>; yields {[12 x i8]*}:array2</i>
3644 %array3 = malloc i32, i32 4, align 1024 <i>; yields {i32*}:array3</i>
3645 %array4 = malloc i32, align 1024 <i>; yields {i32*}:array4</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003646</pre>
Dan Gohmanf3e60bd2009-01-12 23:12:39 +00003647
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003648<p>Note that the code generator does not yet respect the alignment value.</p>
Dan Gohmanf3e60bd2009-01-12 23:12:39 +00003649
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003650</div>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003651
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003652<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003653<div class="doc_subsubsection">
3654 <a name="i_free">'<tt>free</tt>' Instruction</a>
3655</div>
3656
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003657<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003658
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003659<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003660<pre>
Dan Gohman81e21672009-01-04 23:49:44 +00003661 free &lt;type&gt; &lt;value&gt; <i>; yields {void}</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003662</pre>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003663
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003664<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003665<p>The '<tt>free</tt>' instruction returns memory back to the unused memory heap
3666 to be reallocated in the future.</p>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003667
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003668<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003669<p>'<tt>value</tt>' shall be a pointer value that points to a value that was
3670 allocated with the '<tt><a href="#i_malloc">malloc</a></tt>' instruction.</p>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003671
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003672<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003673<p>Access to the memory pointed to by the pointer is no longer defined after
3674 this instruction executes. If the pointer is null, the operation is a
3675 noop.</p>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003676
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003677<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003678<pre>
Dan Gohman81e21672009-01-04 23:49:44 +00003679 %array = <a href="#i_malloc">malloc</a> [4 x i8] <i>; yields {[4 x i8]*}:array</i>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003680 free [4 x i8]* %array
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003681</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003682
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003683</div>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003684
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003685<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003686<div class="doc_subsubsection">
3687 <a name="i_alloca">'<tt>alloca</tt>' Instruction</a>
3688</div>
3689
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003690<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003691
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003692<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003693<pre>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003694 &lt;result&gt; = alloca &lt;type&gt;[, i32 &lt;NumElements&gt;][, align &lt;alignment&gt;] <i>; yields {type*}:result</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003695</pre>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003696
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003697<h5>Overview:</h5>
Jeff Cohen6f1cc772007-04-22 01:17:39 +00003698<p>The '<tt>alloca</tt>' instruction allocates memory on the stack frame of the
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003699 currently executing function, to be automatically released when this function
3700 returns to its caller. The object is always allocated in the generic address
3701 space (address space zero).</p>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003702
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003703<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003704<p>The '<tt>alloca</tt>' instruction
3705 allocates <tt>sizeof(&lt;type&gt;)*NumElements</tt> bytes of memory on the
3706 runtime stack, returning a pointer of the appropriate type to the program.
3707 If "NumElements" is specified, it is the number of elements allocated,
3708 otherwise "NumElements" is defaulted to be one. If a constant alignment is
3709 specified, the value result of the allocation is guaranteed to be aligned to
3710 at least that boundary. If not specified, or if zero, the target can choose
3711 to align the allocation on any convenient boundary compatible with the
3712 type.</p>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003713
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003714<p>'<tt>type</tt>' may be any sized type.</p>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003715
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003716<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendling871eb0a2009-05-08 20:49:29 +00003717<p>Memory is allocated; a pointer is returned. The operation is undefined if
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003718 there is insufficient stack space for the allocation. '<tt>alloca</tt>'d
3719 memory is automatically released when the function returns. The
3720 '<tt>alloca</tt>' instruction is commonly used to represent automatic
3721 variables that must have an address available. When the function returns
3722 (either with the <tt><a href="#i_ret">ret</a></tt>
3723 or <tt><a href="#i_unwind">unwind</a></tt> instructions), the memory is
3724 reclaimed. Allocating zero bytes is legal, but the result is undefined.</p>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003725
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003726<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003727<pre>
Dan Gohman81e21672009-01-04 23:49:44 +00003728 %ptr = alloca i32 <i>; yields {i32*}:ptr</i>
3729 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4 <i>; yields {i32*}:ptr</i>
3730 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4, align 1024 <i>; yields {i32*}:ptr</i>
3731 %ptr = alloca i32, align 1024 <i>; yields {i32*}:ptr</i>
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003732</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003733
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003734</div>
Chris Lattner2cbdc452005-11-06 08:02:57 +00003735
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003736<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00003737<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_load">'<tt>load</tt>'
3738Instruction</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003739
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003740<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003741
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003742<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003743<pre>
3744 &lt;result&gt; = load &lt;ty&gt;* &lt;pointer&gt;[, align &lt;alignment&gt;]
3745 &lt;result&gt; = volatile load &lt;ty&gt;* &lt;pointer&gt;[, align &lt;alignment&gt;]
3746</pre>
3747
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003748<h5>Overview:</h5>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003749<p>The '<tt>load</tt>' instruction is used to read from memory.</p>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003750
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003751<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003752<p>The argument to the '<tt>load</tt>' instruction specifies the memory address
3753 from which to load. The pointer must point to
3754 a <a href="#t_firstclass">first class</a> type. If the <tt>load</tt> is
3755 marked as <tt>volatile</tt>, then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the
3756 number or order of execution of this <tt>load</tt> with other
3757 volatile <tt>load</tt> and <tt><a href="#i_store">store</a></tt>
3758 instructions. </p>
3759
3760<p>The optional constant "align" argument specifies the alignment of the
3761 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0 or an
3762 omitted "align" argument means that the operation has the preferential
3763 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter to
3764 ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
3765 alignment results in an undefined behavior. Underestimating the alignment may
3766 produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always safe.</p>
3767
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003768<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003769<p>The location of memory pointed to is loaded. If the value being loaded is of
3770 scalar type then the number of bytes read does not exceed the minimum number
3771 of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For example, loading an
3772 <tt>i24</tt> reads at most three bytes. When loading a value of a type like
3773 <tt>i20</tt> with a size that is not an integral number of bytes, the result
3774 is undefined if the value was not originally written using a store of the
3775 same type.</p>
3776
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003777<h5>Examples:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003778<pre>
3779 %ptr = <a href="#i_alloca">alloca</a> i32 <i>; yields {i32*}:ptr</i>
3780 <a href="#i_store">store</a> i32 3, i32* %ptr <i>; yields {void}</i>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003781 %val = load i32* %ptr <i>; yields {i32}:val = i32 3</i>
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003782</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003783
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003784</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003785
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003786<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00003787<div class="doc_subsubsection"> <a name="i_store">'<tt>store</tt>'
3788Instruction</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003789
Reid Spencer035ab572006-11-09 21:18:01 +00003790<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003791
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003792<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003793<pre>
3794 store &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt;, &lt;ty&gt;* &lt;pointer&gt;[, align &lt;alignment&gt;] <i>; yields {void}</i>
Christopher Lamb2330e4d2007-04-21 08:16:25 +00003795 volatile store &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt;, &lt;ty&gt;* &lt;pointer&gt;[, align &lt;alignment&gt;] <i>; yields {void}</i>
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003796</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003797
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003798<h5>Overview:</h5>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003799<p>The '<tt>store</tt>' instruction is used to write to memory.</p>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003800
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003801<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003802<p>There are two arguments to the '<tt>store</tt>' instruction: a value to store
3803 and an address at which to store it. The type of the
3804 '<tt>&lt;pointer&gt;</tt>' operand must be a pointer to
3805 the <a href="#t_firstclass">first class</a> type of the
3806 '<tt>&lt;value&gt;</tt>' operand. If the <tt>store</tt> is marked
3807 as <tt>volatile</tt>, then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number
3808 or order of execution of this <tt>store</tt> with other
3809 volatile <tt>load</tt> and <tt><a href="#i_store">store</a></tt>
3810 instructions.</p>
3811
3812<p>The optional constant "align" argument specifies the alignment of the
3813 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0 or an
3814 omitted "align" argument means that the operation has the preferential
3815 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter to
3816 ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
3817 alignment results in an undefined behavior. Underestimating the alignment may
3818 produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always safe.</p>
3819
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00003820<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003821<p>The contents of memory are updated to contain '<tt>&lt;value&gt;</tt>' at the
3822 location specified by the '<tt>&lt;pointer&gt;</tt>' operand. If
3823 '<tt>&lt;value&gt;</tt>' is of scalar type then the number of bytes written
3824 does not exceed the minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the
3825 type. For example, storing an <tt>i24</tt> writes at most three bytes. When
3826 writing a value of a type like <tt>i20</tt> with a size that is not an
3827 integral number of bytes, it is unspecified what happens to the extra bits
3828 that do not belong to the type, but they will typically be overwritten.</p>
3829
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003830<h5>Example:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003831<pre>
3832 %ptr = <a href="#i_alloca">alloca</a> i32 <i>; yields {i32*}:ptr</i>
Bill Wendling8c6c72d2007-10-22 05:10:05 +00003833 store i32 3, i32* %ptr <i>; yields {void}</i>
3834 %val = <a href="#i_load">load</a> i32* %ptr <i>; yields {i32}:val = i32 3</i>
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003835</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003836
Reid Spencer47ce1792006-11-09 21:15:49 +00003837</div>
3838
Chris Lattner2b7d3202002-05-06 03:03:22 +00003839<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003840<div class="doc_subsubsection">
3841 <a name="i_getelementptr">'<tt>getelementptr</tt>' Instruction</a>
3842</div>
3843
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003844<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003845
Chris Lattner7faa8832002-04-14 06:13:44 +00003846<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003847<pre>
Matthijs Kooijmane49d0bc2008-10-13 13:44:15 +00003848 &lt;result&gt; = getelementptr &lt;pty&gt;* &lt;ptrval&gt;{, &lt;ty&gt; &lt;idx&gt;}*
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003849</pre>
3850
Chris Lattner7faa8832002-04-14 06:13:44 +00003851<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003852<p>The '<tt>getelementptr</tt>' instruction is used to get the address of a
3853 subelement of an aggregate data structure. It performs address calculation
3854 only and does not access memory.</p>
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003855
Chris Lattner7faa8832002-04-14 06:13:44 +00003856<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Matthijs Kooijmane49d0bc2008-10-13 13:44:15 +00003857<p>The first argument is always a pointer, and forms the basis of the
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003858 calculation. The remaining arguments are indices, that indicate which of the
3859 elements of the aggregate object are indexed. The interpretation of each
3860 index is dependent on the type being indexed into. The first index always
3861 indexes the pointer value given as the first argument, the second index
3862 indexes a value of the type pointed to (not necessarily the value directly
3863 pointed to, since the first index can be non-zero), etc. The first type
3864 indexed into must be a pointer value, subsequent types can be arrays, vectors
3865 and structs. Note that subsequent types being indexed into can never be
3866 pointers, since that would require loading the pointer before continuing
3867 calculation.</p>
Matthijs Kooijmane49d0bc2008-10-13 13:44:15 +00003868
3869<p>The type of each index argument depends on the type it is indexing into.
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003870 When indexing into a (packed) structure, only <tt>i32</tt> integer
3871 <b>constants</b> are allowed. When indexing into an array, pointer or
3872 vector, integers of any width are allowed (also non-constants).</p>
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003873
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003874<p>For example, let's consider a C code fragment and how it gets compiled to
3875 LLVM:</p>
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003876
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00003877<div class="doc_code">
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003878<pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00003879struct RT {
3880 char A;
Chris Lattnercabc8462007-05-29 15:43:56 +00003881 int B[10][20];
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00003882 char C;
3883};
3884struct ST {
Chris Lattnercabc8462007-05-29 15:43:56 +00003885 int X;
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00003886 double Y;
3887 struct RT Z;
3888};
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003889
Chris Lattnercabc8462007-05-29 15:43:56 +00003890int *foo(struct ST *s) {
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00003891 return &amp;s[1].Z.B[5][13];
3892}
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003893</pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00003894</div>
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003895
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003896<p>The LLVM code generated by the GCC frontend is:</p>
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003897
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00003898<div class="doc_code">
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003899<pre>
Chris Lattnere7886e42009-01-11 20:53:49 +00003900%RT = <a href="#namedtypes">type</a> { i8 , [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }
3901%ST = <a href="#namedtypes">type</a> { i32, double, %RT }
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003902
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00003903define i32* %foo(%ST* %s) {
3904entry:
3905 %reg = getelementptr %ST* %s, i32 1, i32 2, i32 1, i32 5, i32 13
3906 ret i32* %reg
3907}
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003908</pre>
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00003909</div>
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003910
Chris Lattner7faa8832002-04-14 06:13:44 +00003911<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003912<p>In the example above, the first index is indexing into the '<tt>%ST*</tt>'
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003913 type, which is a pointer, yielding a '<tt>%ST</tt>' = '<tt>{ i32, double, %RT
3914 }</tt>' type, a structure. The second index indexes into the third element
3915 of the structure, yielding a '<tt>%RT</tt>' = '<tt>{ i8 , [10 x [20 x i32]],
3916 i8 }</tt>' type, another structure. The third index indexes into the second
3917 element of the structure, yielding a '<tt>[10 x [20 x i32]]</tt>' type, an
3918 array. The two dimensions of the array are subscripted into, yielding an
3919 '<tt>i32</tt>' type. The '<tt>getelementptr</tt>' instruction returns a
3920 pointer to this element, thus computing a value of '<tt>i32*</tt>' type.</p>
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003921
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003922<p>Note that it is perfectly legal to index partially through a structure,
3923 returning a pointer to an inner element. Because of this, the LLVM code for
3924 the given testcase is equivalent to:</p>
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003925
3926<pre>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003927 define i32* %foo(%ST* %s) {
3928 %t1 = getelementptr %ST* %s, i32 1 <i>; yields %ST*:%t1</i>
Jeff Cohen6f1cc772007-04-22 01:17:39 +00003929 %t2 = getelementptr %ST* %t1, i32 0, i32 2 <i>; yields %RT*:%t2</i>
3930 %t3 = getelementptr %RT* %t2, i32 0, i32 1 <i>; yields [10 x [20 x i32]]*:%t3</i>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003931 %t4 = getelementptr [10 x [20 x i32]]* %t3, i32 0, i32 5 <i>; yields [20 x i32]*:%t4</i>
3932 %t5 = getelementptr [20 x i32]* %t4, i32 0, i32 13 <i>; yields i32*:%t5</i>
3933 ret i32* %t5
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003934 }
Chris Lattner6536cfe2002-05-06 22:08:29 +00003935</pre>
Chris Lattnere67a9512005-06-24 17:22:57 +00003936
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003937<p>The getelementptr instruction is often confusing. For some more insight into
3938 how it works, see <a href="GetElementPtr.html">the getelementptr FAQ</a>.</p>
Chris Lattner884a9702006-08-15 00:45:58 +00003939
Chris Lattner7faa8832002-04-14 06:13:44 +00003940<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003941<pre>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003942 <i>; yields [12 x i8]*:aptr</i>
Matthijs Kooijmane49d0bc2008-10-13 13:44:15 +00003943 %aptr = getelementptr {i32, [12 x i8]}* %saptr, i64 0, i32 1
3944 <i>; yields i8*:vptr</i>
Dan Gohman0e451ce2008-10-14 16:51:45 +00003945 %vptr = getelementptr {i32, &lt;2 x i8&gt;}* %svptr, i64 0, i32 1, i32 1
Matthijs Kooijmane49d0bc2008-10-13 13:44:15 +00003946 <i>; yields i8*:eptr</i>
3947 %eptr = getelementptr [12 x i8]* %aptr, i64 0, i32 1
Sanjiv Gupta9f805c22009-04-25 07:27:44 +00003948 <i>; yields i32*:iptr</i>
Sanjiv Gupta16ffa802009-04-24 16:38:13 +00003949 %iptr = getelementptr [10 x i32]* @arr, i16 0, i16 0
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003950</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003951
Chris Lattnerf74d5c72004-04-05 01:30:49 +00003952</div>
Reid Spencer47ce1792006-11-09 21:15:49 +00003953
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00003954<!-- ======================================================================= -->
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +00003955<div class="doc_subsection"> <a name="convertops">Conversion Operations</a>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003956</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003957
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003958<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003959
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +00003960<p>The instructions in this category are the conversion instructions (casting)
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003961 which all take a single operand and a type. They perform various bit
3962 conversions on the operand.</p>
3963
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00003964</div>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00003965
Chris Lattner6536cfe2002-05-06 22:08:29 +00003966<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00003967<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00003968 <a name="i_trunc">'<tt>trunc .. to</tt>' Instruction</a>
3969</div>
3970<div class="doc_text">
3971
3972<h5>Syntax:</h5>
3973<pre>
3974 &lt;result&gt; = trunc &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt; to &lt;ty2&gt; <i>; yields ty2</i>
3975</pre>
3976
3977<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003978<p>The '<tt>trunc</tt>' instruction truncates its operand to the
3979 type <tt>ty2</tt>.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00003980
3981<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003982<p>The '<tt>trunc</tt>' instruction takes a <tt>value</tt> to trunc, which must
3983 be an <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> type, and a type that specifies the
3984 size and type of the result, which must be
3985 an <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> type. The bit size of <tt>value</tt> must
3986 be larger than the bit size of <tt>ty2</tt>. Equal sized types are not
3987 allowed.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00003988
3989<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00003990<p>The '<tt>trunc</tt>' instruction truncates the high order bits
3991 in <tt>value</tt> and converts the remaining bits to <tt>ty2</tt>. Since the
3992 source size must be larger than the destination size, <tt>trunc</tt> cannot
3993 be a <i>no-op cast</i>. It will always truncate bits.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00003994
3995<h5>Example:</h5>
3996<pre>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00003997 %X = trunc i32 257 to i8 <i>; yields i8:1</i>
Reid Spencerc78f3372007-01-12 03:35:51 +00003998 %Y = trunc i32 123 to i1 <i>; yields i1:true</i>
3999 %Y = trunc i32 122 to i1 <i>; yields i1:false</i>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004000</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004001
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004002</div>
4003
4004<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4005<div class="doc_subsubsection">
4006 <a name="i_zext">'<tt>zext .. to</tt>' Instruction</a>
4007</div>
4008<div class="doc_text">
4009
4010<h5>Syntax:</h5>
4011<pre>
4012 &lt;result&gt; = zext &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt; to &lt;ty2&gt; <i>; yields ty2</i>
4013</pre>
4014
4015<h5>Overview:</h5>
4016<p>The '<tt>zext</tt>' instruction zero extends its operand to type
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004017 <tt>ty2</tt>.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004018
4019
4020<h5>Arguments:</h5>
4021<p>The '<tt>zext</tt>' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be of
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004022 <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> type, and a type to cast it to, which must
4023 also be of <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> type. The bit size of the
4024 <tt>value</tt> must be smaller than the bit size of the destination type,
4025 <tt>ty2</tt>.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004026
4027<h5>Semantics:</h5>
4028<p>The <tt>zext</tt> fills the high order bits of the <tt>value</tt> with zero
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004029 bits until it reaches the size of the destination type, <tt>ty2</tt>.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004030
Reid Spencerb5929522007-01-12 15:46:11 +00004031<p>When zero extending from i1, the result will always be either 0 or 1.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004032
4033<h5>Example:</h5>
4034<pre>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00004035 %X = zext i32 257 to i64 <i>; yields i64:257</i>
Reid Spencerc78f3372007-01-12 03:35:51 +00004036 %Y = zext i1 true to i32 <i>; yields i32:1</i>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004037</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004038
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004039</div>
4040
4041<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4042<div class="doc_subsubsection">
4043 <a name="i_sext">'<tt>sext .. to</tt>' Instruction</a>
4044</div>
4045<div class="doc_text">
4046
4047<h5>Syntax:</h5>
4048<pre>
4049 &lt;result&gt; = sext &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt; to &lt;ty2&gt; <i>; yields ty2</i>
4050</pre>
4051
4052<h5>Overview:</h5>
4053<p>The '<tt>sext</tt>' sign extends <tt>value</tt> to the type <tt>ty2</tt>.</p>
4054
4055<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004056<p>The '<tt>sext</tt>' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be of
4057 <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> type, and a type to cast it to, which must
4058 also be of <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> type. The bit size of the
4059 <tt>value</tt> must be smaller than the bit size of the destination type,
4060 <tt>ty2</tt>.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004061
4062<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004063<p>The '<tt>sext</tt>' instruction performs a sign extension by copying the sign
4064 bit (highest order bit) of the <tt>value</tt> until it reaches the bit size
4065 of the type <tt>ty2</tt>.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004066
Reid Spencerc78f3372007-01-12 03:35:51 +00004067<p>When sign extending from i1, the extension always results in -1 or 0.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004068
4069<h5>Example:</h5>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004070<pre>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00004071 %X = sext i8 -1 to i16 <i>; yields i16 :65535</i>
Reid Spencerc78f3372007-01-12 03:35:51 +00004072 %Y = sext i1 true to i32 <i>; yields i32:-1</i>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004073</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004074
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004075</div>
4076
4077<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4078<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencer3fa91b02006-11-09 21:48:10 +00004079 <a name="i_fptrunc">'<tt>fptrunc .. to</tt>' Instruction</a>
4080</div>
4081
4082<div class="doc_text">
4083
4084<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Reid Spencer3fa91b02006-11-09 21:48:10 +00004085<pre>
4086 &lt;result&gt; = fptrunc &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt; to &lt;ty2&gt; <i>; yields ty2</i>
4087</pre>
4088
4089<h5>Overview:</h5>
4090<p>The '<tt>fptrunc</tt>' instruction truncates <tt>value</tt> to type
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004091 <tt>ty2</tt>.</p>
Reid Spencer3fa91b02006-11-09 21:48:10 +00004092
4093<h5>Arguments:</h5>
4094<p>The '<tt>fptrunc</tt>' instruction takes a <a href="#t_floating">floating
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004095 point</a> value to cast and a <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> type
4096 to cast it to. The size of <tt>value</tt> must be larger than the size of
4097 <tt>ty2</tt>. This implies that <tt>fptrunc</tt> cannot be used to make a
4098 <i>no-op cast</i>.</p>
Reid Spencer3fa91b02006-11-09 21:48:10 +00004099
4100<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004101<p>The '<tt>fptrunc</tt>' instruction truncates a <tt>value</tt> from a larger
4102 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> type to a smaller
4103 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> type. If the value cannot fit
4104 within the destination type, <tt>ty2</tt>, then the results are
4105 undefined.</p>
Reid Spencer3fa91b02006-11-09 21:48:10 +00004106
4107<h5>Example:</h5>
4108<pre>
4109 %X = fptrunc double 123.0 to float <i>; yields float:123.0</i>
4110 %Y = fptrunc double 1.0E+300 to float <i>; yields undefined</i>
4111</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004112
Reid Spencer3fa91b02006-11-09 21:48:10 +00004113</div>
4114
4115<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4116<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004117 <a name="i_fpext">'<tt>fpext .. to</tt>' Instruction</a>
4118</div>
4119<div class="doc_text">
4120
4121<h5>Syntax:</h5>
4122<pre>
4123 &lt;result&gt; = fpext &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt; to &lt;ty2&gt; <i>; yields ty2</i>
4124</pre>
4125
4126<h5>Overview:</h5>
4127<p>The '<tt>fpext</tt>' extends a floating point <tt>value</tt> to a larger
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004128 floating point value.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004129
4130<h5>Arguments:</h5>
4131<p>The '<tt>fpext</tt>' instruction takes a
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004132 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> <tt>value</tt> to cast, and
4133 a <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> type to cast it to. The source
4134 type must be smaller than the destination type.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004135
4136<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00004137<p>The '<tt>fpext</tt>' instruction extends the <tt>value</tt> from a smaller
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004138 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> type to a larger
4139 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> type. The <tt>fpext</tt> cannot be
4140 used to make a <i>no-op cast</i> because it always changes bits. Use
4141 <tt>bitcast</tt> to make a <i>no-op cast</i> for a floating point cast.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004142
4143<h5>Example:</h5>
4144<pre>
4145 %X = fpext float 3.1415 to double <i>; yields double:3.1415</i>
4146 %Y = fpext float 1.0 to float <i>; yields float:1.0 (no-op)</i>
4147</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004148
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004149</div>
4150
4151<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4152<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencer24d6da52007-01-21 00:29:26 +00004153 <a name="i_fptoui">'<tt>fptoui .. to</tt>' Instruction</a>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004154</div>
4155<div class="doc_text">
4156
4157<h5>Syntax:</h5>
4158<pre>
Reid Spencer1539a1c2007-07-31 14:40:14 +00004159 &lt;result&gt; = fptoui &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt; to &lt;ty2&gt; <i>; yields ty2</i>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004160</pre>
4161
4162<h5>Overview:</h5>
Reid Spencer1539a1c2007-07-31 14:40:14 +00004163<p>The '<tt>fptoui</tt>' converts a floating point <tt>value</tt> to its
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004164 unsigned integer equivalent of type <tt>ty2</tt>.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004165
4166<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004167<p>The '<tt>fptoui</tt>' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
4168 scalar or vector <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> value, and a type
4169 to cast it to <tt>ty2</tt>, which must be an <a href="#t_integer">integer</a>
4170 type. If <tt>ty</tt> is a vector floating point type, <tt>ty2</tt> must be a
4171 vector integer type with the same number of elements as <tt>ty</tt></p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004172
4173<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004174<p>The '<tt>fptoui</tt>' instruction converts its
4175 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> operand into the nearest (rounding
4176 towards zero) unsigned integer value. If the value cannot fit
4177 in <tt>ty2</tt>, the results are undefined.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004178
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004179<h5>Example:</h5>
4180<pre>
Reid Spencer1539a1c2007-07-31 14:40:14 +00004181 %X = fptoui double 123.0 to i32 <i>; yields i32:123</i>
Chris Lattner88519042007-09-22 03:17:52 +00004182 %Y = fptoui float 1.0E+300 to i1 <i>; yields undefined:1</i>
Reid Spencer1539a1c2007-07-31 14:40:14 +00004183 %X = fptoui float 1.04E+17 to i8 <i>; yields undefined:1</i>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004184</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004185
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004186</div>
4187
4188<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4189<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00004190 <a name="i_fptosi">'<tt>fptosi .. to</tt>' Instruction</a>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004191</div>
4192<div class="doc_text">
4193
4194<h5>Syntax:</h5>
4195<pre>
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00004196 &lt;result&gt; = fptosi &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt; to &lt;ty2&gt; <i>; yields ty2</i>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004197</pre>
4198
4199<h5>Overview:</h5>
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00004200<p>The '<tt>fptosi</tt>' instruction converts
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004201 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> <tt>value</tt> to
4202 type <tt>ty2</tt>.</p>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004203
Chris Lattner6536cfe2002-05-06 22:08:29 +00004204<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004205<p>The '<tt>fptosi</tt>' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
4206 scalar or vector <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> value, and a type
4207 to cast it to <tt>ty2</tt>, which must be an <a href="#t_integer">integer</a>
4208 type. If <tt>ty</tt> is a vector floating point type, <tt>ty2</tt> must be a
4209 vector integer type with the same number of elements as <tt>ty</tt></p>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004210
Chris Lattner6536cfe2002-05-06 22:08:29 +00004211<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00004212<p>The '<tt>fptosi</tt>' instruction converts its
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004213 <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> operand into the nearest (rounding
4214 towards zero) signed integer value. If the value cannot fit in <tt>ty2</tt>,
4215 the results are undefined.</p>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004216
Chris Lattner33ba0d92001-07-09 00:26:23 +00004217<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004218<pre>
Reid Spencerc78f3372007-01-12 03:35:51 +00004219 %X = fptosi double -123.0 to i32 <i>; yields i32:-123</i>
Chris Lattner88519042007-09-22 03:17:52 +00004220 %Y = fptosi float 1.0E-247 to i1 <i>; yields undefined:1</i>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00004221 %X = fptosi float 1.04E+17 to i8 <i>; yields undefined:1</i>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004222</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004223
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004224</div>
4225
4226<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4227<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00004228 <a name="i_uitofp">'<tt>uitofp .. to</tt>' Instruction</a>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004229</div>
4230<div class="doc_text">
4231
4232<h5>Syntax:</h5>
4233<pre>
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00004234 &lt;result&gt; = uitofp &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt; to &lt;ty2&gt; <i>; yields ty2</i>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004235</pre>
4236
4237<h5>Overview:</h5>
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00004238<p>The '<tt>uitofp</tt>' instruction regards <tt>value</tt> as an unsigned
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004239 integer and converts that value to the <tt>ty2</tt> type.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004240
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004241<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Nate Begemanb348d182007-11-17 03:58:34 +00004242<p>The '<tt>uitofp</tt>' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004243 scalar or vector <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> value, and a type to cast
4244 it to <tt>ty2</tt>, which must be an <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a>
4245 type. If <tt>ty</tt> is a vector integer type, <tt>ty2</tt> must be a vector
4246 floating point type with the same number of elements as <tt>ty</tt></p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004247
4248<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00004249<p>The '<tt>uitofp</tt>' instruction interprets its operand as an unsigned
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004250 integer quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point
4251 value. If the value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results are
4252 undefined.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004253
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004254<h5>Example:</h5>
4255<pre>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00004256 %X = uitofp i32 257 to float <i>; yields float:257.0</i>
Dan Gohman0e451ce2008-10-14 16:51:45 +00004257 %Y = uitofp i8 -1 to double <i>; yields double:255.0</i>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004258</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004259
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004260</div>
4261
4262<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4263<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00004264 <a name="i_sitofp">'<tt>sitofp .. to</tt>' Instruction</a>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004265</div>
4266<div class="doc_text">
4267
4268<h5>Syntax:</h5>
4269<pre>
Reid Spencerd4448792006-11-09 23:03:26 +00004270 &lt;result&gt; = sitofp &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt; to &lt;ty2&gt; <i>; yields ty2</i>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004271</pre>
4272
4273<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004274<p>The '<tt>sitofp</tt>' instruction regards <tt>value</tt> as a signed integer
4275 and converts that value to the <tt>ty2</tt> type.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004276
4277<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Nate Begemanb348d182007-11-17 03:58:34 +00004278<p>The '<tt>sitofp</tt>' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004279 scalar or vector <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> value, and a type to cast
4280 it to <tt>ty2</tt>, which must be an <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a>
4281 type. If <tt>ty</tt> is a vector integer type, <tt>ty2</tt> must be a vector
4282 floating point type with the same number of elements as <tt>ty</tt></p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004283
4284<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004285<p>The '<tt>sitofp</tt>' instruction interprets its operand as a signed integer
4286 quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point value. If the
4287 value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results are undefined.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004288
4289<h5>Example:</h5>
4290<pre>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00004291 %X = sitofp i32 257 to float <i>; yields float:257.0</i>
Dan Gohman0e451ce2008-10-14 16:51:45 +00004292 %Y = sitofp i8 -1 to double <i>; yields double:-1.0</i>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004293</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004294
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004295</div>
4296
4297<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4298<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencer72679252006-11-11 21:00:47 +00004299 <a name="i_ptrtoint">'<tt>ptrtoint .. to</tt>' Instruction</a>
4300</div>
4301<div class="doc_text">
4302
4303<h5>Syntax:</h5>
4304<pre>
4305 &lt;result&gt; = ptrtoint &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt; to &lt;ty2&gt; <i>; yields ty2</i>
4306</pre>
4307
4308<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004309<p>The '<tt>ptrtoint</tt>' instruction converts the pointer <tt>value</tt> to
4310 the integer type <tt>ty2</tt>.</p>
Reid Spencer72679252006-11-11 21:00:47 +00004311
4312<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004313<p>The '<tt>ptrtoint</tt>' instruction takes a <tt>value</tt> to cast, which
4314 must be a <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a> value, and a type to cast it to
4315 <tt>ty2</tt>, which must be an <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> type.</p>
Reid Spencer72679252006-11-11 21:00:47 +00004316
4317<h5>Semantics:</h5>
4318<p>The '<tt>ptrtoint</tt>' instruction converts <tt>value</tt> to integer type
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004319 <tt>ty2</tt> by interpreting the pointer value as an integer and either
4320 truncating or zero extending that value to the size of the integer type. If
4321 <tt>value</tt> is smaller than <tt>ty2</tt> then a zero extension is done. If
4322 <tt>value</tt> is larger than <tt>ty2</tt> then a truncation is done. If they
4323 are the same size, then nothing is done (<i>no-op cast</i>) other than a type
4324 change.</p>
Reid Spencer72679252006-11-11 21:00:47 +00004325
4326<h5>Example:</h5>
4327<pre>
Jeff Cohenb627eab2007-04-29 01:07:00 +00004328 %X = ptrtoint i32* %X to i8 <i>; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture</i>
4329 %Y = ptrtoint i32* %x to i64 <i>; yields zero extension on 32-bit architecture</i>
Reid Spencer72679252006-11-11 21:00:47 +00004330</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004331
Reid Spencer72679252006-11-11 21:00:47 +00004332</div>
4333
4334<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4335<div class="doc_subsubsection">
4336 <a name="i_inttoptr">'<tt>inttoptr .. to</tt>' Instruction</a>
4337</div>
4338<div class="doc_text">
4339
4340<h5>Syntax:</h5>
4341<pre>
4342 &lt;result&gt; = inttoptr &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt; to &lt;ty2&gt; <i>; yields ty2</i>
4343</pre>
4344
4345<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004346<p>The '<tt>inttoptr</tt>' instruction converts an integer <tt>value</tt> to a
4347 pointer type, <tt>ty2</tt>.</p>
Reid Spencer72679252006-11-11 21:00:47 +00004348
4349<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Duncan Sands8036ca42007-03-30 12:22:09 +00004350<p>The '<tt>inttoptr</tt>' instruction takes an <a href="#t_integer">integer</a>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004351 value to cast, and a type to cast it to, which must be a
4352 <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a> type.</p>
Reid Spencer72679252006-11-11 21:00:47 +00004353
4354<h5>Semantics:</h5>
4355<p>The '<tt>inttoptr</tt>' instruction converts <tt>value</tt> to type
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004356 <tt>ty2</tt> by applying either a zero extension or a truncation depending on
4357 the size of the integer <tt>value</tt>. If <tt>value</tt> is larger than the
4358 size of a pointer then a truncation is done. If <tt>value</tt> is smaller
4359 than the size of a pointer then a zero extension is done. If they are the
4360 same size, nothing is done (<i>no-op cast</i>).</p>
Reid Spencer72679252006-11-11 21:00:47 +00004361
4362<h5>Example:</h5>
4363<pre>
Jeff Cohenb627eab2007-04-29 01:07:00 +00004364 %X = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* <i>; yields zero extension on 64-bit architecture</i>
4365 %X = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* <i>; yields no-op on 32-bit architecture</i>
4366 %Y = inttoptr i64 0 to i32* <i>; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture</i>
Reid Spencer72679252006-11-11 21:00:47 +00004367</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004368
Reid Spencer72679252006-11-11 21:00:47 +00004369</div>
4370
4371<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4372<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencer5c0ef472006-11-11 23:08:07 +00004373 <a name="i_bitcast">'<tt>bitcast .. to</tt>' Instruction</a>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004374</div>
4375<div class="doc_text">
4376
4377<h5>Syntax:</h5>
4378<pre>
Reid Spencer5c0ef472006-11-11 23:08:07 +00004379 &lt;result&gt; = bitcast &lt;ty&gt; &lt;value&gt; to &lt;ty2&gt; <i>; yields ty2</i>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004380</pre>
4381
4382<h5>Overview:</h5>
Reid Spencer5c0ef472006-11-11 23:08:07 +00004383<p>The '<tt>bitcast</tt>' instruction converts <tt>value</tt> to type
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004384 <tt>ty2</tt> without changing any bits.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004385
4386<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004387<p>The '<tt>bitcast</tt>' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
4388 non-aggregate first class value, and a type to cast it to, which must also be
4389 a non-aggregate <a href="#t_firstclass">first class</a> type. The bit sizes
4390 of <tt>value</tt> and the destination type, <tt>ty2</tt>, must be
4391 identical. If the source type is a pointer, the destination type must also be
4392 a pointer. This instruction supports bitwise conversion of vectors to
4393 integers and to vectors of other types (as long as they have the same
4394 size).</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004395
4396<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Reid Spencer5c0ef472006-11-11 23:08:07 +00004397<p>The '<tt>bitcast</tt>' instruction converts <tt>value</tt> to type
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004398 <tt>ty2</tt>. It is always a <i>no-op cast</i> because no bits change with
4399 this conversion. The conversion is done as if the <tt>value</tt> had been
4400 stored to memory and read back as type <tt>ty2</tt>. Pointer types may only
4401 be converted to other pointer types with this instruction. To convert
4402 pointers to other types, use the <a href="#i_inttoptr">inttoptr</a> or
4403 <a href="#i_ptrtoint">ptrtoint</a> instructions first.</p>
Reid Spencer9dee3ac2006-11-08 01:11:31 +00004404
4405<h5>Example:</h5>
4406<pre>
Jeff Cohenb627eab2007-04-29 01:07:00 +00004407 %X = bitcast i8 255 to i8 <i>; yields i8 :-1</i>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00004408 %Y = bitcast i32* %x to sint* <i>; yields sint*:%x</i>
Dan Gohman0e451ce2008-10-14 16:51:45 +00004409 %Z = bitcast &lt;2 x int&gt; %V to i64; <i>; yields i64: %V</i>
Chris Lattner33ba0d92001-07-09 00:26:23 +00004410</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004411
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00004412</div>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004413
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +00004414<!-- ======================================================================= -->
4415<div class="doc_subsection"> <a name="otherops">Other Operations</a> </div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004416
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +00004417<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004418
4419<p>The instructions in this category are the "miscellaneous" instructions, which
4420 defy better classification.</p>
4421
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +00004422</div>
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004423
4424<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4425<div class="doc_subsubsection"><a name="i_icmp">'<tt>icmp</tt>' Instruction</a>
4426</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004427
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004428<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004429
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004430<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004431<pre>
4432 &lt;result&gt; = icmp &lt;cond&gt; &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {i1} or {&lt;N x i1&gt;}:result</i>
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004433</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004434
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004435<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004436<p>The '<tt>icmp</tt>' instruction returns a boolean value or a vector of
4437 boolean values based on comparison of its two integer, integer vector, or
4438 pointer operands.</p>
4439
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004440<h5>Arguments:</h5>
4441<p>The '<tt>icmp</tt>' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004442 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is not a
4443 value, just a keyword. The possible condition code are:</p>
4444
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004445<ol>
4446 <li><tt>eq</tt>: equal</li>
4447 <li><tt>ne</tt>: not equal </li>
4448 <li><tt>ugt</tt>: unsigned greater than</li>
4449 <li><tt>uge</tt>: unsigned greater or equal</li>
4450 <li><tt>ult</tt>: unsigned less than</li>
4451 <li><tt>ule</tt>: unsigned less or equal</li>
4452 <li><tt>sgt</tt>: signed greater than</li>
4453 <li><tt>sge</tt>: signed greater or equal</li>
4454 <li><tt>slt</tt>: signed less than</li>
4455 <li><tt>sle</tt>: signed less or equal</li>
4456</ol>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004457
Chris Lattner3b19d652007-01-15 01:54:13 +00004458<p>The remaining two arguments must be <a href="#t_integer">integer</a> or
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004459 <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a> or integer <a href="#t_vector">vector</a>
4460 typed. They must also be identical types.</p>
4461
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004462<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004463<p>The '<tt>icmp</tt>' compares <tt>op1</tt> and <tt>op2</tt> according to the
4464 condition code given as <tt>cond</tt>. The comparison performed always yields
4465 either an <a href="#t_primitive"><tt>i1</tt></a> or vector of <tt>i1</tt>
4466 result, as follows:</p>
4467
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004468<ol>
4469 <li><tt>eq</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if the operands are equal,
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004470 <tt>false</tt> otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or
4471 performed.</li>
4472
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004473 <li><tt>ne</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if the operands are unequal,
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004474 <tt>false</tt> otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or
4475 performed.</li>
4476
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004477 <li><tt>ugt</tt>: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004478 <tt>true</tt> if <tt>op1</tt> is greater than <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4479
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004480 <li><tt>uge</tt>: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004481 <tt>true</tt> if <tt>op1</tt> is greater than or equal
4482 to <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4483
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004484 <li><tt>ult</tt>: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004485 <tt>true</tt> if <tt>op1</tt> is less than <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4486
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004487 <li><tt>ule</tt>: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004488 <tt>true</tt> if <tt>op1</tt> is less than or equal to <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4489
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004490 <li><tt>sgt</tt>: interprets the operands as signed values and yields
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004491 <tt>true</tt> if <tt>op1</tt> is greater than <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4492
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004493 <li><tt>sge</tt>: interprets the operands as signed values and yields
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004494 <tt>true</tt> if <tt>op1</tt> is greater than or equal
4495 to <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4496
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004497 <li><tt>slt</tt>: interprets the operands as signed values and yields
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004498 <tt>true</tt> if <tt>op1</tt> is less than <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4499
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004500 <li><tt>sle</tt>: interprets the operands as signed values and yields
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004501 <tt>true</tt> if <tt>op1</tt> is less than or equal to <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004502</ol>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004503
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004504<p>If the operands are <a href="#t_pointer">pointer</a> typed, the pointer
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004505 values are compared as if they were integers.</p>
4506
4507<p>If the operands are integer vectors, then they are compared element by
4508 element. The result is an <tt>i1</tt> vector with the same number of elements
4509 as the values being compared. Otherwise, the result is an <tt>i1</tt>.</p>
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004510
4511<h5>Example:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004512<pre>
4513 &lt;result&gt; = icmp eq i32 4, 5 <i>; yields: result=false</i>
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00004514 &lt;result&gt; = icmp ne float* %X, %X <i>; yields: result=false</i>
4515 &lt;result&gt; = icmp ult i16 4, 5 <i>; yields: result=true</i>
4516 &lt;result&gt; = icmp sgt i16 4, 5 <i>; yields: result=false</i>
4517 &lt;result&gt; = icmp ule i16 -4, 5 <i>; yields: result=false</i>
4518 &lt;result&gt; = icmp sge i16 4, 5 <i>; yields: result=false</i>
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004519</pre>
Dan Gohmanc766f722009-01-22 01:39:38 +00004520
4521<p>Note that the code generator does not yet support vector types with
4522 the <tt>icmp</tt> instruction.</p>
4523
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004524</div>
4525
4526<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4527<div class="doc_subsubsection"><a name="i_fcmp">'<tt>fcmp</tt>' Instruction</a>
4528</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004529
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004530<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004531
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004532<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004533<pre>
4534 &lt;result&gt; = fcmp &lt;cond&gt; &lt;ty&gt; &lt;op1&gt;, &lt;op2&gt; <i>; yields {i1} or {&lt;N x i1&gt;}:result</i>
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004535</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004536
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004537<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004538<p>The '<tt>fcmp</tt>' instruction returns a boolean value or vector of boolean
4539 values based on comparison of its operands.</p>
4540
4541<p>If the operands are floating point scalars, then the result type is a boolean
4542(<a href="#t_primitive"><tt>i1</tt></a>).</p>
4543
4544<p>If the operands are floating point vectors, then the result type is a vector
4545 of boolean with the same number of elements as the operands being
4546 compared.</p>
4547
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004548<h5>Arguments:</h5>
4549<p>The '<tt>fcmp</tt>' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004550 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is not a
4551 value, just a keyword. The possible condition code are:</p>
4552
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004553<ol>
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004554 <li><tt>false</tt>: no comparison, always returns false</li>
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004555 <li><tt>oeq</tt>: ordered and equal</li>
4556 <li><tt>ogt</tt>: ordered and greater than </li>
4557 <li><tt>oge</tt>: ordered and greater than or equal</li>
4558 <li><tt>olt</tt>: ordered and less than </li>
4559 <li><tt>ole</tt>: ordered and less than or equal</li>
4560 <li><tt>one</tt>: ordered and not equal</li>
4561 <li><tt>ord</tt>: ordered (no nans)</li>
4562 <li><tt>ueq</tt>: unordered or equal</li>
4563 <li><tt>ugt</tt>: unordered or greater than </li>
4564 <li><tt>uge</tt>: unordered or greater than or equal</li>
4565 <li><tt>ult</tt>: unordered or less than </li>
4566 <li><tt>ule</tt>: unordered or less than or equal</li>
4567 <li><tt>une</tt>: unordered or not equal</li>
4568 <li><tt>uno</tt>: unordered (either nans)</li>
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004569 <li><tt>true</tt>: no comparison, always returns true</li>
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004570</ol>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004571
Jeff Cohenb627eab2007-04-29 01:07:00 +00004572<p><i>Ordered</i> means that neither operand is a QNAN while
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004573 <i>unordered</i> means that either operand may be a QNAN.</p>
4574
4575<p>Each of <tt>val1</tt> and <tt>val2</tt> arguments must be either
4576 a <a href="#t_floating">floating point</a> type or
4577 a <a href="#t_vector">vector</a> of floating point type. They must have
4578 identical types.</p>
4579
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004580<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Gabor Greiffb224a22008-08-07 21:46:00 +00004581<p>The '<tt>fcmp</tt>' instruction compares <tt>op1</tt> and <tt>op2</tt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004582 according to the condition code given as <tt>cond</tt>. If the operands are
4583 vectors, then the vectors are compared element by element. Each comparison
4584 performed always yields an <a href="#t_primitive">i1</a> result, as
4585 follows:</p>
4586
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004587<ol>
4588 <li><tt>false</tt>: always yields <tt>false</tt>, regardless of operands.</li>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004589
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004590 <li><tt>oeq</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if both operands are not a QNAN and
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004591 <tt>op1</tt> is equal to <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4592
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004593 <li><tt>ogt</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if both operands are not a QNAN and
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004594 <tt>op1</tt> is greather than <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4595
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004596 <li><tt>oge</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if both operands are not a QNAN and
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004597 <tt>op1</tt> is greater than or equal to <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4598
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004599 <li><tt>olt</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if both operands are not a QNAN and
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004600 <tt>op1</tt> is less than <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4601
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004602 <li><tt>ole</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if both operands are not a QNAN and
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004603 <tt>op1</tt> is less than or equal to <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4604
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004605 <li><tt>one</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if both operands are not a QNAN and
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004606 <tt>op1</tt> is not equal to <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4607
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004608 <li><tt>ord</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if both operands are not a QNAN.</li>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004609
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004610 <li><tt>ueq</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if either operand is a QNAN or
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004611 <tt>op1</tt> is equal to <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4612
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004613 <li><tt>ugt</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if either operand is a QNAN or
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004614 <tt>op1</tt> is greater than <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4615
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004616 <li><tt>uge</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if either operand is a QNAN or
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004617 <tt>op1</tt> is greater than or equal to <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4618
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004619 <li><tt>ult</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if either operand is a QNAN or
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004620 <tt>op1</tt> is less than <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4621
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004622 <li><tt>ule</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if either operand is a QNAN or
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004623 <tt>op1</tt> is less than or equal to <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4624
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004625 <li><tt>une</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if either operand is a QNAN or
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004626 <tt>op1</tt> is not equal to <tt>op2</tt>.</li>
4627
Reid Spencerb7f26282006-11-19 03:00:14 +00004628 <li><tt>uno</tt>: yields <tt>true</tt> if either operand is a QNAN.</li>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004629
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004630 <li><tt>true</tt>: always yields <tt>true</tt>, regardless of operands.</li>
4631</ol>
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004632
4633<h5>Example:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004634<pre>
4635 &lt;result&gt; = fcmp oeq float 4.0, 5.0 <i>; yields: result=false</i>
Dan Gohmanf72fb672008-09-09 01:02:47 +00004636 &lt;result&gt; = fcmp one float 4.0, 5.0 <i>; yields: result=true</i>
4637 &lt;result&gt; = fcmp olt float 4.0, 5.0 <i>; yields: result=true</i>
4638 &lt;result&gt; = fcmp ueq double 1.0, 2.0 <i>; yields: result=false</i>
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004639</pre>
Dan Gohmanc766f722009-01-22 01:39:38 +00004640
4641<p>Note that the code generator does not yet support vector types with
4642 the <tt>fcmp</tt> instruction.</p>
4643
Reid Spencerf3a70a62006-11-18 21:50:54 +00004644</div>
4645
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +00004646<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Nate Begemanac80ade2008-05-12 19:01:56 +00004647<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00004648 <a name="i_phi">'<tt>phi</tt>' Instruction</a>
4649</div>
4650
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +00004651<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00004652
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +00004653<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004654<pre>
4655 &lt;result&gt; = phi &lt;ty&gt; [ &lt;val0&gt;, &lt;label0&gt;], ...
4656</pre>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00004657
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +00004658<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004659<p>The '<tt>phi</tt>' instruction is used to implement the &#966; node in the
4660 SSA graph representing the function.</p>
4661
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +00004662<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004663<p>The type of the incoming values is specified with the first type field. After
4664 this, the '<tt>phi</tt>' instruction takes a list of pairs as arguments, with
4665 one pair for each predecessor basic block of the current block. Only values
4666 of <a href="#t_firstclass">first class</a> type may be used as the value
4667 arguments to the PHI node. Only labels may be used as the label
4668 arguments.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00004669
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004670<p>There must be no non-phi instructions between the start of a basic block and
4671 the PHI instructions: i.e. PHI instructions must be first in a basic
4672 block.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00004673
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004674<p>For the purposes of the SSA form, the use of each incoming value is deemed to
4675 occur on the edge from the corresponding predecessor block to the current
4676 block (but after any definition of an '<tt>invoke</tt>' instruction's return
4677 value on the same edge).</p>
Jay Foadd2449092009-06-03 10:20:10 +00004678
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +00004679<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Jeff Cohenb627eab2007-04-29 01:07:00 +00004680<p>At runtime, the '<tt>phi</tt>' instruction logically takes on the value
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004681 specified by the pair corresponding to the predecessor basic block that
4682 executed just prior to the current block.</p>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00004683
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +00004684<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattner5568e942008-05-20 20:48:21 +00004685<pre>
4686Loop: ; Infinite loop that counts from 0 on up...
4687 %indvar = phi i32 [ 0, %LoopHeader ], [ %nextindvar, %Loop ]
4688 %nextindvar = add i32 %indvar, 1
4689 br label %Loop
4690</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004691
Reid Spencer2fd21e62006-11-08 01:18:52 +00004692</div>
4693
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004694<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4695<div class="doc_subsubsection">
4696 <a name="i_select">'<tt>select</tt>' Instruction</a>
4697</div>
4698
4699<div class="doc_text">
4700
4701<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004702<pre>
Dan Gohmanf72fb672008-09-09 01:02:47 +00004703 &lt;result&gt; = select <i>selty</i> &lt;cond&gt;, &lt;ty&gt; &lt;val1&gt;, &lt;ty&gt; &lt;val2&gt; <i>; yields ty</i>
4704
Dan Gohman0e451ce2008-10-14 16:51:45 +00004705 <i>selty</i> is either i1 or {&lt;N x i1&gt;}
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004706</pre>
4707
4708<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004709<p>The '<tt>select</tt>' instruction is used to choose one value based on a
4710 condition, without branching.</p>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004711
4712
4713<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004714<p>The '<tt>select</tt>' instruction requires an 'i1' value or a vector of 'i1'
4715 values indicating the condition, and two values of the
4716 same <a href="#t_firstclass">first class</a> type. If the val1/val2 are
4717 vectors and the condition is a scalar, then entire vectors are selected, not
4718 individual elements.</p>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004719
4720<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004721<p>If the condition is an i1 and it evaluates to 1, the instruction returns the
4722 first value argument; otherwise, it returns the second value argument.</p>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004723
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004724<p>If the condition is a vector of i1, then the value arguments must be vectors
4725 of the same size, and the selection is done element by element.</p>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004726
4727<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004728<pre>
Reid Spencerc78f3372007-01-12 03:35:51 +00004729 %X = select i1 true, i8 17, i8 42 <i>; yields i8:17</i>
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004730</pre>
Dan Gohmanc766f722009-01-22 01:39:38 +00004731
4732<p>Note that the code generator does not yet support conditions
4733 with vector type.</p>
4734
Chris Lattnercc37aae2004-03-12 05:50:16 +00004735</div>
4736
Robert Bocchino05ccd702006-01-15 20:48:27 +00004737<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
4738<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Chris Lattner2bff5242005-05-06 05:47:36 +00004739 <a name="i_call">'<tt>call</tt>' Instruction</a>
4740</div>
4741
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00004742<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner2bff5242005-05-06 05:47:36 +00004743
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00004744<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner2bff5242005-05-06 05:47:36 +00004745<pre>
Devang Patel307e8ab2008-10-07 17:48:33 +00004746 &lt;result&gt; = [tail] call [<a href="#callingconv">cconv</a>] [<a href="#paramattrs">ret attrs</a>] &lt;ty&gt; [&lt;fnty&gt;*] &lt;fnptrval&gt;(&lt;function args&gt;) [<a href="#fnattrs">fn attrs</a>]
Chris Lattner2bff5242005-05-06 05:47:36 +00004747</pre>
4748
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00004749<h5>Overview:</h5>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00004750<p>The '<tt>call</tt>' instruction represents a simple function call.</p>
Chris Lattner2bff5242005-05-06 05:47:36 +00004751
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00004752<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00004753<p>This instruction requires several arguments:</p>
Chris Lattner2bff5242005-05-06 05:47:36 +00004754
Chris Lattner6536cfe2002-05-06 22:08:29 +00004755<ol>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004756 <li>The optional "tail" marker indicates whether the callee function accesses
4757 any allocas or varargs in the caller. If the "tail" marker is present,
4758 the function call is eligible for tail call optimization. Note that calls
4759 may be marked "tail" even if they do not occur before
4760 a <a href="#i_ret"><tt>ret</tt></a> instruction.</li>
Devang Patelf642f472008-10-06 18:50:38 +00004761
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004762 <li>The optional "cconv" marker indicates which <a href="#callingconv">calling
4763 convention</a> the call should use. If none is specified, the call
4764 defaults to using C calling conventions.</li>
Devang Patelf642f472008-10-06 18:50:38 +00004765
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004766 <li>The optional <a href="#paramattrs">Parameter Attributes</a> list for
4767 return values. Only '<tt>zeroext</tt>', '<tt>signext</tt>', and
4768 '<tt>inreg</tt>' attributes are valid here.</li>
4769
4770 <li>'<tt>ty</tt>': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
4771 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
4772 <tt><a href="#t_void">void</a></tt>.</li>
4773
4774 <li>'<tt>fnty</tt>': shall be the signature of the pointer to function value
4775 being invoked. The argument types must match the types implied by this
4776 signature. This type can be omitted if the function is not varargs and if
4777 the function type does not return a pointer to a function.</li>
4778
4779 <li>'<tt>fnptrval</tt>': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
4780 be invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function invocation, but
4781 indirect <tt>call</tt>s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
4782 to function value.</li>
4783
4784 <li>'<tt>function args</tt>': argument list whose types match the function
4785 signature argument types. All arguments must be of
4786 <a href="#t_firstclass">first class</a> type. If the function signature
4787 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the extra
4788 arguments can be specified.</li>
4789
4790 <li>The optional <a href="#fnattrs">function attributes</a> list. Only
4791 '<tt>noreturn</tt>', '<tt>nounwind</tt>', '<tt>readonly</tt>' and
4792 '<tt>readnone</tt>' attributes are valid here.</li>
Chris Lattner6536cfe2002-05-06 22:08:29 +00004793</ol>
Chris Lattner2bff5242005-05-06 05:47:36 +00004794
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00004795<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004796<p>The '<tt>call</tt>' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to
4797 a specified function, with its incoming arguments bound to the specified
4798 values. Upon a '<tt><a href="#i_ret">ret</a></tt>' instruction in the called
4799 function, control flow continues with the instruction after the function
4800 call, and the return value of the function is bound to the result
4801 argument.</p>
Chris Lattner2bff5242005-05-06 05:47:36 +00004802
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00004803<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattner2bff5242005-05-06 05:47:36 +00004804<pre>
Nick Lewyckydb7e3c92007-09-08 13:57:50 +00004805 %retval = call i32 @test(i32 %argc)
Chris Lattner772fccf2008-03-21 17:24:17 +00004806 call i32 (i8 *, ...)* @printf(i8 * %msg, i32 12, i8 42) <i>; yields i32</i>
4807 %X = tail call i32 @foo() <i>; yields i32</i>
4808 %Y = tail call <a href="#callingconv">fastcc</a> i32 @foo() <i>; yields i32</i>
4809 call void %foo(i8 97 signext)
Devang Patelc3fc6df2008-03-10 20:49:15 +00004810
4811 %struct.A = type { i32, i8 }
Devang Patelf642f472008-10-06 18:50:38 +00004812 %r = call %struct.A @foo() <i>; yields { 32, i8 }</i>
Dan Gohmanb1e6b962008-10-04 19:00:07 +00004813 %gr = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 0 <i>; yields i32</i>
4814 %gr1 = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 1 <i>; yields i8</i>
Chris Lattner85a350f2008-10-08 06:26:11 +00004815 %Z = call void @foo() noreturn <i>; indicates that %foo never returns normally</i>
Matthijs Kooijmancb73d192008-10-07 10:03:45 +00004816 %ZZ = call zeroext i32 @bar() <i>; Return value is %zero extended</i>
Chris Lattner2bff5242005-05-06 05:47:36 +00004817</pre>
4818
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00004819</div>
Chris Lattnere19d7a72004-09-27 21:51:25 +00004820
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00004821<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattnere19d7a72004-09-27 21:51:25 +00004822<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Chris Lattnerfb6977d2006-01-13 23:26:01 +00004823 <a name="i_va_arg">'<tt>va_arg</tt>' Instruction</a>
Chris Lattnere19d7a72004-09-27 21:51:25 +00004824</div>
4825
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00004826<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnere19d7a72004-09-27 21:51:25 +00004827
Chris Lattner8d1a81d2003-10-18 05:51:36 +00004828<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattnere19d7a72004-09-27 21:51:25 +00004829<pre>
Andrew Lenharth8bf607a2005-06-18 18:28:17 +00004830 &lt;resultval&gt; = va_arg &lt;va_list*&gt; &lt;arglist&gt;, &lt;argty&gt;
Chris Lattnere19d7a72004-09-27 21:51:25 +00004831</pre>
4832
Chris Lattner8d1a81d2003-10-18 05:51:36 +00004833<h5>Overview:</h5>
Andrew Lenharth8bf607a2005-06-18 18:28:17 +00004834<p>The '<tt>va_arg</tt>' instruction is used to access arguments passed through
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004835 the "variable argument" area of a function call. It is used to implement the
4836 <tt>va_arg</tt> macro in C.</p>
Chris Lattnere19d7a72004-09-27 21:51:25 +00004837
Chris Lattner8d1a81d2003-10-18 05:51:36 +00004838<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004839<p>This instruction takes a <tt>va_list*</tt> value and the type of the
4840 argument. It returns a value of the specified argument type and increments
4841 the <tt>va_list</tt> to point to the next argument. The actual type
4842 of <tt>va_list</tt> is target specific.</p>
Chris Lattnere19d7a72004-09-27 21:51:25 +00004843
Chris Lattner8d1a81d2003-10-18 05:51:36 +00004844<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004845<p>The '<tt>va_arg</tt>' instruction loads an argument of the specified type
4846 from the specified <tt>va_list</tt> and causes the <tt>va_list</tt> to point
4847 to the next argument. For more information, see the variable argument
4848 handling <a href="#int_varargs">Intrinsic Functions</a>.</p>
Chris Lattnere19d7a72004-09-27 21:51:25 +00004849
4850<p>It is legal for this instruction to be called in a function which does not
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004851 take a variable number of arguments, for example, the <tt>vfprintf</tt>
4852 function.</p>
Chris Lattnere19d7a72004-09-27 21:51:25 +00004853
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004854<p><tt>va_arg</tt> is an LLVM instruction instead of
4855 an <a href="#intrinsics">intrinsic function</a> because it takes a type as an
4856 argument.</p>
Chris Lattnere19d7a72004-09-27 21:51:25 +00004857
Chris Lattner8d1a81d2003-10-18 05:51:36 +00004858<h5>Example:</h5>
Chris Lattnere19d7a72004-09-27 21:51:25 +00004859<p>See the <a href="#int_varargs">variable argument processing</a> section.</p>
4860
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004861<p>Note that the code generator does not yet fully support va_arg on many
4862 targets. Also, it does not currently support va_arg with aggregate types on
4863 any target.</p>
Dan Gohmanf3e60bd2009-01-12 23:12:39 +00004864
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00004865</div>
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00004866
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00004867<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattner261efe92003-11-25 01:02:51 +00004868<div class="doc_section"> <a name="intrinsics">Intrinsic Functions</a> </div>
4869<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00004870
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00004871<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00004872
4873<p>LLVM supports the notion of an "intrinsic function". These functions have
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004874 well known names and semantics and are required to follow certain
4875 restrictions. Overall, these intrinsics represent an extension mechanism for
4876 the LLVM language that does not require changing all of the transformations
4877 in LLVM when adding to the language (or the bitcode reader/writer, the
4878 parser, etc...).</p>
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00004879
John Criswellfc6b8952005-05-16 16:17:45 +00004880<p>Intrinsic function names must all start with an "<tt>llvm.</tt>" prefix. This
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004881 prefix is reserved in LLVM for intrinsic names; thus, function names may not
4882 begin with this prefix. Intrinsic functions must always be external
4883 functions: you cannot define the body of intrinsic functions. Intrinsic
4884 functions may only be used in call or invoke instructions: it is illegal to
4885 take the address of an intrinsic function. Additionally, because intrinsic
4886 functions are part of the LLVM language, it is required if any are added that
4887 they be documented here.</p>
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00004888
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004889<p>Some intrinsic functions can be overloaded, i.e., the intrinsic represents a
4890 family of functions that perform the same operation but on different data
4891 types. Because LLVM can represent over 8 million different integer types,
4892 overloading is used commonly to allow an intrinsic function to operate on any
4893 integer type. One or more of the argument types or the result type can be
4894 overloaded to accept any integer type. Argument types may also be defined as
4895 exactly matching a previous argument's type or the result type. This allows
4896 an intrinsic function which accepts multiple arguments, but needs all of them
4897 to be of the same type, to only be overloaded with respect to a single
4898 argument or the result.</p>
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00004899
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004900<p>Overloaded intrinsics will have the names of its overloaded argument types
4901 encoded into its function name, each preceded by a period. Only those types
4902 which are overloaded result in a name suffix. Arguments whose type is matched
4903 against another type do not. For example, the <tt>llvm.ctpop</tt> function
4904 can take an integer of any width and returns an integer of exactly the same
4905 integer width. This leads to a family of functions such as
4906 <tt>i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %val)</tt> and <tt>i29 @llvm.ctpop.i29(i29
4907 %val)</tt>. Only one type, the return type, is overloaded, and only one type
4908 suffix is required. Because the argument's type is matched against the return
4909 type, it does not require its own name suffix.</p>
Reid Spencer409e28f2007-04-01 08:04:23 +00004910
4911<p>To learn how to add an intrinsic function, please see the
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004912 <a href="ExtendingLLVM.html">Extending LLVM Guide</a>.</p>
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00004913
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00004914</div>
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00004915
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00004916<!-- ======================================================================= -->
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00004917<div class="doc_subsection">
4918 <a name="int_varargs">Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics</a>
4919</div>
4920
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00004921<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00004922
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004923<p>Variable argument support is defined in LLVM with
4924 the <a href="#i_va_arg"><tt>va_arg</tt></a> instruction and these three
4925 intrinsic functions. These functions are related to the similarly named
4926 macros defined in the <tt>&lt;stdarg.h&gt;</tt> header file.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00004927
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004928<p>All of these functions operate on arguments that use a target-specific value
4929 type "<tt>va_list</tt>". The LLVM assembly language reference manual does
4930 not define what this type is, so all transformations should be prepared to
4931 handle these functions regardless of the type used.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00004932
Chris Lattner374ab302006-05-15 17:26:46 +00004933<p>This example shows how the <a href="#i_va_arg"><tt>va_arg</tt></a>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004934 instruction and the variable argument handling intrinsic functions are
4935 used.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00004936
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00004937<div class="doc_code">
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00004938<pre>
Anton Korobeynikov5d522f32007-03-21 23:58:04 +00004939define i32 @test(i32 %X, ...) {
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00004940 ; Initialize variable argument processing
Jeff Cohenb627eab2007-04-29 01:07:00 +00004941 %ap = alloca i8*
Chris Lattnerb75137d2007-01-08 07:55:15 +00004942 %ap2 = bitcast i8** %ap to i8*
Anton Korobeynikov5d522f32007-03-21 23:58:04 +00004943 call void @llvm.va_start(i8* %ap2)
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00004944
4945 ; Read a single integer argument
Jeff Cohenb627eab2007-04-29 01:07:00 +00004946 %tmp = va_arg i8** %ap, i32
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00004947
4948 ; Demonstrate usage of llvm.va_copy and llvm.va_end
Jeff Cohenb627eab2007-04-29 01:07:00 +00004949 %aq = alloca i8*
Chris Lattnerb75137d2007-01-08 07:55:15 +00004950 %aq2 = bitcast i8** %aq to i8*
Jeff Cohenb627eab2007-04-29 01:07:00 +00004951 call void @llvm.va_copy(i8* %aq2, i8* %ap2)
Anton Korobeynikov5d522f32007-03-21 23:58:04 +00004952 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %aq2)
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00004953
4954 ; Stop processing of arguments.
Anton Korobeynikov5d522f32007-03-21 23:58:04 +00004955 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %ap2)
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00004956 ret i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00004957}
Anton Korobeynikov5d522f32007-03-21 23:58:04 +00004958
4959declare void @llvm.va_start(i8*)
4960declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8*, i8*)
4961declare void @llvm.va_end(i8*)
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00004962</pre>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00004963</div>
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00004964
Bill Wendling2f7a8b02007-05-29 09:04:49 +00004965</div>
4966
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00004967<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00004968<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00004969 <a name="int_va_start">'<tt>llvm.va_start</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00004970</div>
4971
4972
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00004973<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004974
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00004975<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004976<pre>
4977 declare void %llvm.va_start(i8* &lt;arglist&gt;)
4978</pre>
4979
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00004980<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004981<p>The '<tt>llvm.va_start</tt>' intrinsic initializes <tt>*&lt;arglist&gt;</tt>
4982 for subsequent use by <tt><a href="#i_va_arg">va_arg</a></tt>.</p>
Andrew Lenharth8bf607a2005-06-18 18:28:17 +00004983
4984<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Dan Gohman0e451ce2008-10-14 16:51:45 +00004985<p>The argument is a pointer to a <tt>va_list</tt> element to initialize.</p>
Andrew Lenharth8bf607a2005-06-18 18:28:17 +00004986
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00004987<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Dan Gohman0e451ce2008-10-14 16:51:45 +00004988<p>The '<tt>llvm.va_start</tt>' intrinsic works just like the <tt>va_start</tt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00004989 macro available in C. In a target-dependent way, it initializes
4990 the <tt>va_list</tt> element to which the argument points, so that the next
4991 call to <tt>va_arg</tt> will produce the first variable argument passed to
4992 the function. Unlike the C <tt>va_start</tt> macro, this intrinsic does not
4993 need to know the last argument of the function as the compiler can figure
4994 that out.</p>
Andrew Lenharth8bf607a2005-06-18 18:28:17 +00004995
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00004996</div>
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00004997
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00004998<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00004999<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005000 <a name="int_va_end">'<tt>llvm.va_end</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00005001</div>
5002
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00005003<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerb75137d2007-01-08 07:55:15 +00005004
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005005<h5>Syntax:</h5>
5006<pre>
5007 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8* &lt;arglist&gt;)
5008</pre>
5009
5010<h5>Overview:</h5>
Jeff Cohenb627eab2007-04-29 01:07:00 +00005011<p>The '<tt>llvm.va_end</tt>' intrinsic destroys <tt>*&lt;arglist&gt;</tt>,
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005012 which has been initialized previously
5013 with <tt><a href="#int_va_start">llvm.va_start</a></tt>
5014 or <tt><a href="#i_va_copy">llvm.va_copy</a></tt>.</p>
Chris Lattnerb75137d2007-01-08 07:55:15 +00005015
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00005016<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Jeff Cohenb627eab2007-04-29 01:07:00 +00005017<p>The argument is a pointer to a <tt>va_list</tt> to destroy.</p>
Chris Lattnerb75137d2007-01-08 07:55:15 +00005018
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00005019<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00005020<p>The '<tt>llvm.va_end</tt>' intrinsic works just like the <tt>va_end</tt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005021 macro available in C. In a target-dependent way, it destroys
5022 the <tt>va_list</tt> element to which the argument points. Calls
5023 to <a href="#int_va_start"><tt>llvm.va_start</tt></a>
5024 and <a href="#int_va_copy"> <tt>llvm.va_copy</tt></a> must be matched exactly
5025 with calls to <tt>llvm.va_end</tt>.</p>
Chris Lattnerb75137d2007-01-08 07:55:15 +00005026
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00005027</div>
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00005028
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00005029<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00005030<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005031 <a name="int_va_copy">'<tt>llvm.va_copy</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00005032</div>
5033
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00005034<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005035
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00005036<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005037<pre>
Anton Korobeynikovec43a062007-03-22 00:02:17 +00005038 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8* &lt;destarglist&gt;, i8* &lt;srcarglist&gt;)
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005039</pre>
5040
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00005041<h5>Overview:</h5>
Jeff Cohenb627eab2007-04-29 01:07:00 +00005042<p>The '<tt>llvm.va_copy</tt>' intrinsic copies the current argument position
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005043 from the source argument list to the destination argument list.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005044
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00005045<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Andrew Lenharth8bf607a2005-06-18 18:28:17 +00005046<p>The first argument is a pointer to a <tt>va_list</tt> element to initialize.
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005047 The second argument is a pointer to a <tt>va_list</tt> element to copy
5048 from.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005049
Chris Lattnerd9ad5b32003-05-08 04:57:36 +00005050<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Jeff Cohenb627eab2007-04-29 01:07:00 +00005051<p>The '<tt>llvm.va_copy</tt>' intrinsic works just like the <tt>va_copy</tt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005052 macro available in C. In a target-dependent way, it copies the
5053 source <tt>va_list</tt> element into the destination <tt>va_list</tt>
5054 element. This intrinsic is necessary because
5055 the <tt><a href="#int_va_start"> llvm.va_start</a></tt> intrinsic may be
5056 arbitrarily complex and require, for example, memory allocation.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005057
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00005058</div>
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00005059
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00005060<!-- ======================================================================= -->
5061<div class="doc_subsection">
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005062 <a name="int_gc">Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics</a>
5063</div>
5064
5065<div class="doc_text">
5066
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005067<p>LLVM support for <a href="GarbageCollection.html">Accurate Garbage
Chris Lattnerd3eda892008-08-05 18:29:16 +00005068Collection</a> (GC) requires the implementation and generation of these
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005069intrinsics. These intrinsics allow identification of <a href="#int_gcroot">GC
5070roots on the stack</a>, as well as garbage collector implementations that
5071require <a href="#int_gcread">read</a> and <a href="#int_gcwrite">write</a>
5072barriers. Front-ends for type-safe garbage collected languages should generate
5073these intrinsics to make use of the LLVM garbage collectors. For more details,
5074see <a href="GarbageCollection.html">Accurate Garbage Collection with
5075LLVM</a>.</p>
Christopher Lamb303dae92007-12-17 01:00:21 +00005076
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005077<p>The garbage collection intrinsics only operate on objects in the generic
5078 address space (address space zero).</p>
Christopher Lamb303dae92007-12-17 01:00:21 +00005079
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005080</div>
5081
5082<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5083<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005084 <a name="int_gcroot">'<tt>llvm.gcroot</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005085</div>
5086
5087<div class="doc_text">
5088
5089<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005090<pre>
Chris Lattner1df4f752007-09-21 17:30:40 +00005091 declare void @llvm.gcroot(i8** %ptrloc, i8* %metadata)
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005092</pre>
5093
5094<h5>Overview:</h5>
John Criswell9e2485c2004-12-10 15:51:16 +00005095<p>The '<tt>llvm.gcroot</tt>' intrinsic declares the existence of a GC root to
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005096 the code generator, and allows some metadata to be associated with it.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005097
5098<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005099<p>The first argument specifies the address of a stack object that contains the
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005100 root pointer. The second pointer (which must be either a constant or a
5101 global value address) contains the meta-data to be associated with the
5102 root.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005103
5104<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Chris Lattner05d67092008-04-24 05:59:56 +00005105<p>At runtime, a call to this intrinsic stores a null pointer into the "ptrloc"
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005106 location. At compile-time, the code generator generates information to allow
5107 the runtime to find the pointer at GC safe points. The '<tt>llvm.gcroot</tt>'
5108 intrinsic may only be used in a function which <a href="#gc">specifies a GC
5109 algorithm</a>.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005110
5111</div>
5112
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005113<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5114<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005115 <a name="int_gcread">'<tt>llvm.gcread</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005116</div>
5117
5118<div class="doc_text">
5119
5120<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005121<pre>
Chris Lattner1df4f752007-09-21 17:30:40 +00005122 declare i8* @llvm.gcread(i8* %ObjPtr, i8** %Ptr)
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005123</pre>
5124
5125<h5>Overview:</h5>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005126<p>The '<tt>llvm.gcread</tt>' intrinsic identifies reads of references from heap
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005127 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require read
5128 barriers.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005129
5130<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Chris Lattner80626e92006-03-14 20:02:51 +00005131<p>The second argument is the address to read from, which should be an address
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005132 allocated from the garbage collector. The first object is a pointer to the
5133 start of the referenced object, if needed by the language runtime (otherwise
5134 null).</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005135
5136<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005137<p>The '<tt>llvm.gcread</tt>' intrinsic has the same semantics as a load
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005138 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by the
5139 garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '<tt>llvm.gcread</tt>' intrinsic
5140 may only be used in a function which <a href="#gc">specifies a GC
5141 algorithm</a>.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005142
5143</div>
5144
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005145<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5146<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005147 <a name="int_gcwrite">'<tt>llvm.gcwrite</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005148</div>
5149
5150<div class="doc_text">
5151
5152<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005153<pre>
Chris Lattner1df4f752007-09-21 17:30:40 +00005154 declare void @llvm.gcwrite(i8* %P1, i8* %Obj, i8** %P2)
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005155</pre>
5156
5157<h5>Overview:</h5>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005158<p>The '<tt>llvm.gcwrite</tt>' intrinsic identifies writes of references to heap
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005159 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require write
5160 barriers (such as generational or reference counting collectors).</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005161
5162<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Chris Lattner80626e92006-03-14 20:02:51 +00005163<p>The first argument is the reference to store, the second is the start of the
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005164 object to store it to, and the third is the address of the field of Obj to
5165 store to. If the runtime does not require a pointer to the object, Obj may
5166 be null.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005167
5168<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005169<p>The '<tt>llvm.gcwrite</tt>' intrinsic has the same semantics as a store
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005170 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by the
5171 garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '<tt>llvm.gcwrite</tt>' intrinsic
5172 may only be used in a function which <a href="#gc">specifies a GC
5173 algorithm</a>.</p>
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005174
5175</div>
5176
Chris Lattnerd7923912004-05-23 21:06:01 +00005177<!-- ======================================================================= -->
5178<div class="doc_subsection">
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005179 <a name="int_codegen">Code Generator Intrinsics</a>
5180</div>
5181
5182<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005183
5184<p>These intrinsics are provided by LLVM to expose special features that may
5185 only be implemented with code generator support.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005186
5187</div>
5188
5189<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5190<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005191 <a name="int_returnaddress">'<tt>llvm.returnaddress</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005192</div>
5193
5194<div class="doc_text">
5195
5196<h5>Syntax:</h5>
5197<pre>
Anton Korobeynikovec43a062007-03-22 00:02:17 +00005198 declare i8 *@llvm.returnaddress(i32 &lt;level&gt;)
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005199</pre>
5200
5201<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005202<p>The '<tt>llvm.returnaddress</tt>' intrinsic attempts to compute a
5203 target-specific value indicating the return address of the current function
5204 or one of its callers.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005205
5206<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005207<p>The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the address
5208 for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its caller, etc.
5209 The argument is <b>required</b> to be a constant integer value.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005210
5211<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005212<p>The '<tt>llvm.returnaddress</tt>' intrinsic either returns a pointer
5213 indicating the return address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
5214 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to be
5215 incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be used for
5216 debugging purposes.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005217
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005218<p>Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or other
5219 aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that of the
5220 obvious source-language caller.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005221
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005222</div>
5223
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005224<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5225<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005226 <a name="int_frameaddress">'<tt>llvm.frameaddress</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005227</div>
5228
5229<div class="doc_text">
5230
5231<h5>Syntax:</h5>
5232<pre>
Chris Lattner1df4f752007-09-21 17:30:40 +00005233 declare i8 *@llvm.frameaddress(i32 &lt;level&gt;)
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005234</pre>
5235
5236<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005237<p>The '<tt>llvm.frameaddress</tt>' intrinsic attempts to return the
5238 target-specific frame pointer value for the specified stack frame.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005239
5240<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005241<p>The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the frame
5242 pointer for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its caller,
5243 etc. The argument is <b>required</b> to be a constant integer value.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005244
5245<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005246<p>The '<tt>llvm.frameaddress</tt>' intrinsic either returns a pointer
5247 indicating the frame address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
5248 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to be
5249 incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be used for
5250 debugging purposes.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005251
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005252<p>Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or other
5253 aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that of the
5254 obvious source-language caller.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005255
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005256</div>
5257
Chris Lattner9a9d7ac2005-02-28 19:24:19 +00005258<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5259<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005260 <a name="int_stacksave">'<tt>llvm.stacksave</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattner57e1f392006-01-13 02:03:13 +00005261</div>
5262
5263<div class="doc_text">
5264
5265<h5>Syntax:</h5>
5266<pre>
Chris Lattner1df4f752007-09-21 17:30:40 +00005267 declare i8 *@llvm.stacksave()
Chris Lattner57e1f392006-01-13 02:03:13 +00005268</pre>
5269
5270<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005271<p>The '<tt>llvm.stacksave</tt>' intrinsic is used to remember the current state
5272 of the function stack, for use
5273 with <a href="#int_stackrestore"> <tt>llvm.stackrestore</tt></a>. This is
5274 useful for implementing language features like scoped automatic variable
5275 sized arrays in C99.</p>
Chris Lattner57e1f392006-01-13 02:03:13 +00005276
5277<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005278<p>This intrinsic returns a opaque pointer value that can be passed
5279 to <a href="#int_stackrestore"><tt>llvm.stackrestore</tt></a>. When
5280 an <tt>llvm.stackrestore</tt> intrinsic is executed with a value saved
5281 from <tt>llvm.stacksave</tt>, it effectively restores the state of the stack
5282 to the state it was in when the <tt>llvm.stacksave</tt> intrinsic executed.
5283 In practice, this pops any <a href="#i_alloca">alloca</a> blocks from the
5284 stack that were allocated after the <tt>llvm.stacksave</tt> was executed.</p>
Chris Lattner57e1f392006-01-13 02:03:13 +00005285
5286</div>
5287
5288<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5289<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005290 <a name="int_stackrestore">'<tt>llvm.stackrestore</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattner57e1f392006-01-13 02:03:13 +00005291</div>
5292
5293<div class="doc_text">
5294
5295<h5>Syntax:</h5>
5296<pre>
Anton Korobeynikovec43a062007-03-22 00:02:17 +00005297 declare void @llvm.stackrestore(i8 * %ptr)
Chris Lattner57e1f392006-01-13 02:03:13 +00005298</pre>
5299
5300<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005301<p>The '<tt>llvm.stackrestore</tt>' intrinsic is used to restore the state of
5302 the function stack to the state it was in when the
5303 corresponding <a href="#int_stacksave"><tt>llvm.stacksave</tt></a> intrinsic
5304 executed. This is useful for implementing language features like scoped
5305 automatic variable sized arrays in C99.</p>
Chris Lattner57e1f392006-01-13 02:03:13 +00005306
5307<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005308<p>See the description
5309 for <a href="#int_stacksave"><tt>llvm.stacksave</tt></a>.</p>
Chris Lattner57e1f392006-01-13 02:03:13 +00005310
5311</div>
5312
Chris Lattner57e1f392006-01-13 02:03:13 +00005313<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5314<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005315 <a name="int_prefetch">'<tt>llvm.prefetch</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattner9a9d7ac2005-02-28 19:24:19 +00005316</div>
5317
5318<div class="doc_text">
5319
5320<h5>Syntax:</h5>
5321<pre>
Chris Lattner1df4f752007-09-21 17:30:40 +00005322 declare void @llvm.prefetch(i8* &lt;address&gt;, i32 &lt;rw&gt;, i32 &lt;locality&gt;)
Chris Lattner9a9d7ac2005-02-28 19:24:19 +00005323</pre>
5324
5325<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005326<p>The '<tt>llvm.prefetch</tt>' intrinsic is a hint to the code generator to
5327 insert a prefetch instruction if supported; otherwise, it is a noop.
5328 Prefetches have no effect on the behavior of the program but can change its
5329 performance characteristics.</p>
Chris Lattner9a9d7ac2005-02-28 19:24:19 +00005330
5331<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005332<p><tt>address</tt> is the address to be prefetched, <tt>rw</tt> is the
5333 specifier determining if the fetch should be for a read (0) or write (1),
5334 and <tt>locality</tt> is a temporal locality specifier ranging from (0) - no
5335 locality, to (3) - extremely local keep in cache. The <tt>rw</tt>
5336 and <tt>locality</tt> arguments must be constant integers.</p>
Chris Lattner9a9d7ac2005-02-28 19:24:19 +00005337
5338<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005339<p>This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. In particular,
5340 prefetches cannot trap and do not produce a value. On targets that support
5341 this intrinsic, the prefetch can provide hints to the processor cache for
5342 better performance.</p>
Chris Lattner9a9d7ac2005-02-28 19:24:19 +00005343
5344</div>
5345
Andrew Lenharth7f4ec3b2005-03-28 20:05:49 +00005346<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5347<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005348 <a name="int_pcmarker">'<tt>llvm.pcmarker</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Andrew Lenharth7f4ec3b2005-03-28 20:05:49 +00005349</div>
5350
5351<div class="doc_text">
5352
5353<h5>Syntax:</h5>
5354<pre>
Chris Lattner1df4f752007-09-21 17:30:40 +00005355 declare void @llvm.pcmarker(i32 &lt;id&gt;)
Andrew Lenharth7f4ec3b2005-03-28 20:05:49 +00005356</pre>
5357
5358<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005359<p>The '<tt>llvm.pcmarker</tt>' intrinsic is a method to export a Program
5360 Counter (PC) in a region of code to simulators and other tools. The method
5361 is target specific, but it is expected that the marker will use exported
5362 symbols to transmit the PC of the marker. The marker makes no guarantees
5363 that it will remain with any specific instruction after optimizations. It is
5364 possible that the presence of a marker will inhibit optimizations. The
5365 intended use is to be inserted after optimizations to allow correlations of
5366 simulation runs.</p>
Andrew Lenharth7f4ec3b2005-03-28 20:05:49 +00005367
5368<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005369<p><tt>id</tt> is a numerical id identifying the marker.</p>
Andrew Lenharth7f4ec3b2005-03-28 20:05:49 +00005370
5371<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005372<p>This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. Backends that do
5373 not support this intrinisic may ignore it.</p>
Andrew Lenharth7f4ec3b2005-03-28 20:05:49 +00005374
5375</div>
5376
Andrew Lenharth51b8d542005-11-11 16:47:30 +00005377<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5378<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005379 <a name="int_readcyclecounter">'<tt>llvm.readcyclecounter</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Andrew Lenharth51b8d542005-11-11 16:47:30 +00005380</div>
5381
5382<div class="doc_text">
5383
5384<h5>Syntax:</h5>
5385<pre>
Anton Korobeynikovec43a062007-03-22 00:02:17 +00005386 declare i64 @llvm.readcyclecounter( )
Andrew Lenharth51b8d542005-11-11 16:47:30 +00005387</pre>
5388
5389<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005390<p>The '<tt>llvm.readcyclecounter</tt>' intrinsic provides access to the cycle
5391 counter register (or similar low latency, high accuracy clocks) on those
5392 targets that support it. On X86, it should map to RDTSC. On Alpha, it
5393 should map to RPCC. As the backing counters overflow quickly (on the order
5394 of 9 seconds on alpha), this should only be used for small timings.</p>
Andrew Lenharth51b8d542005-11-11 16:47:30 +00005395
5396<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005397<p>When directly supported, reading the cycle counter should not modify any
5398 memory. Implementations are allowed to either return a application specific
5399 value or a system wide value. On backends without support, this is lowered
5400 to a constant 0.</p>
Andrew Lenharth51b8d542005-11-11 16:47:30 +00005401
5402</div>
5403
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005404<!-- ======================================================================= -->
5405<div class="doc_subsection">
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00005406 <a name="int_libc">Standard C Library Intrinsics</a>
5407</div>
5408
5409<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005410
5411<p>LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important standard C library functions.
5412 These intrinsics allow source-language front-ends to pass information about
5413 the alignment of the pointer arguments to the code generator, providing
5414 opportunity for more efficient code generation.</p>
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00005415
5416</div>
5417
5418<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5419<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005420 <a name="int_memcpy">'<tt>llvm.memcpy</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00005421</div>
5422
5423<div class="doc_text">
5424
5425<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005426<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.memcpy</tt> on any
5427 integer bit width. Not all targets support all bit widths however.</p>
5428
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00005429<pre>
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00005430 declare void @llvm.memcpy.i8(i8 * &lt;dest&gt;, i8 * &lt;src&gt;,
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005431 i8 &lt;len&gt;, i32 &lt;align&gt;)
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00005432 declare void @llvm.memcpy.i16(i8 * &lt;dest&gt;, i8 * &lt;src&gt;,
5433 i16 &lt;len&gt;, i32 &lt;align&gt;)
Anton Korobeynikovec43a062007-03-22 00:02:17 +00005434 declare void @llvm.memcpy.i32(i8 * &lt;dest&gt;, i8 * &lt;src&gt;,
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00005435 i32 &lt;len&gt;, i32 &lt;align&gt;)
Anton Korobeynikovec43a062007-03-22 00:02:17 +00005436 declare void @llvm.memcpy.i64(i8 * &lt;dest&gt;, i8 * &lt;src&gt;,
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00005437 i64 &lt;len&gt;, i32 &lt;align&gt;)
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00005438</pre>
5439
5440<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005441<p>The '<tt>llvm.memcpy.*</tt>' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
5442 source location to the destination location.</p>
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00005443
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005444<p>Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the <tt>llvm.memcpy.*</tt>
5445 intrinsics do not return a value, and takes an extra alignment argument.</p>
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00005446
5447<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005448<p>The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a pointer
5449 to the source. The third argument is an integer argument specifying the
5450 number of bytes to copy, and the fourth argument is the alignment of the
5451 source and destination locations.</p>
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00005452
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005453<p>If the call to this intrinisic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
5454 then the caller guarantees that both the source and destination pointers are
5455 aligned to that boundary.</p>
Chris Lattner3301ced2004-02-12 21:18:15 +00005456
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00005457<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005458<p>The '<tt>llvm.memcpy.*</tt>' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
5459 source location to the destination location, which are not allowed to
5460 overlap. It copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known to
5461 be aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument,
5462 otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1.</p>
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00005463
Chris Lattner33aec9e2004-02-12 17:01:32 +00005464</div>
5465
Chris Lattner0eb51b42004-02-12 18:10:10 +00005466<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5467<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005468 <a name="int_memmove">'<tt>llvm.memmove</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattner0eb51b42004-02-12 18:10:10 +00005469</div>
5470
5471<div class="doc_text">
5472
5473<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00005474<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memmove on any integer bit
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005475 width. Not all targets support all bit widths however.</p>
5476
Chris Lattner0eb51b42004-02-12 18:10:10 +00005477<pre>
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00005478 declare void @llvm.memmove.i8(i8 * &lt;dest&gt;, i8 * &lt;src&gt;,
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005479 i8 &lt;len&gt;, i32 &lt;align&gt;)
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00005480 declare void @llvm.memmove.i16(i8 * &lt;dest&gt;, i8 * &lt;src&gt;,
5481 i16 &lt;len&gt;, i32 &lt;align&gt;)
Anton Korobeynikovec43a062007-03-22 00:02:17 +00005482 declare void @llvm.memmove.i32(i8 * &lt;dest&gt;, i8 * &lt;src&gt;,
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00005483 i32 &lt;len&gt;, i32 &lt;align&gt;)
Anton Korobeynikovec43a062007-03-22 00:02:17 +00005484 declare void @llvm.memmove.i64(i8 * &lt;dest&gt;, i8 * &lt;src&gt;,
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00005485 i64 &lt;len&gt;, i32 &lt;align&gt;)
Chris Lattner0eb51b42004-02-12 18:10:10 +00005486</pre>
5487
5488<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005489<p>The '<tt>llvm.memmove.*</tt>' intrinsics move a block of memory from the
5490 source location to the destination location. It is similar to the
5491 '<tt>llvm.memcpy</tt>' intrinsic but allows the two memory locations to
5492 overlap.</p>
Chris Lattner0eb51b42004-02-12 18:10:10 +00005493
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005494<p>Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the <tt>llvm.memmove.*</tt>
5495 intrinsics do not return a value, and takes an extra alignment argument.</p>
Chris Lattner0eb51b42004-02-12 18:10:10 +00005496
5497<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005498<p>The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a pointer
5499 to the source. The third argument is an integer argument specifying the
5500 number of bytes to copy, and the fourth argument is the alignment of the
5501 source and destination locations.</p>
Chris Lattner0eb51b42004-02-12 18:10:10 +00005502
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005503<p>If the call to this intrinisic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
5504 then the caller guarantees that the source and destination pointers are
5505 aligned to that boundary.</p>
Chris Lattner3301ced2004-02-12 21:18:15 +00005506
Chris Lattner0eb51b42004-02-12 18:10:10 +00005507<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005508<p>The '<tt>llvm.memmove.*</tt>' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
5509 source location to the destination location, which may overlap. It copies
5510 "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known to be aligned to some
5511 boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument, otherwise it should
5512 be set to 0 or 1.</p>
Chris Lattner0eb51b42004-02-12 18:10:10 +00005513
Chris Lattner0eb51b42004-02-12 18:10:10 +00005514</div>
5515
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005516<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5517<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005518 <a name="int_memset">'<tt>llvm.memset.*</tt>' Intrinsics</a>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005519</div>
5520
5521<div class="doc_text">
5522
5523<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00005524<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memset on any integer bit
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005525 width. Not all targets support all bit widths however.</p>
5526
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005527<pre>
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00005528 declare void @llvm.memset.i8(i8 * &lt;dest&gt;, i8 &lt;val&gt;,
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005529 i8 &lt;len&gt;, i32 &lt;align&gt;)
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00005530 declare void @llvm.memset.i16(i8 * &lt;dest&gt;, i8 &lt;val&gt;,
5531 i16 &lt;len&gt;, i32 &lt;align&gt;)
Anton Korobeynikovec43a062007-03-22 00:02:17 +00005532 declare void @llvm.memset.i32(i8 * &lt;dest&gt;, i8 &lt;val&gt;,
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00005533 i32 &lt;len&gt;, i32 &lt;align&gt;)
Anton Korobeynikovec43a062007-03-22 00:02:17 +00005534 declare void @llvm.memset.i64(i8 * &lt;dest&gt;, i8 &lt;val&gt;,
Reid Spencerca86e162006-12-31 07:07:53 +00005535 i64 &lt;len&gt;, i32 &lt;align&gt;)
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005536</pre>
5537
5538<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005539<p>The '<tt>llvm.memset.*</tt>' intrinsics fill a block of memory with a
5540 particular byte value.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005541
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005542<p>Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the <tt>llvm.memset</tt>
5543 intrinsic does not return a value, and takes an extra alignment argument.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005544
5545<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005546<p>The first argument is a pointer to the destination to fill, the second is the
5547 byte value to fill it with, the third argument is an integer argument
5548 specifying the number of bytes to fill, and the fourth argument is the known
5549 alignment of destination location.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005550
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005551<p>If the call to this intrinisic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
5552 then the caller guarantees that the destination pointer is aligned to that
5553 boundary.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005554
5555<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005556<p>The '<tt>llvm.memset.*</tt>' intrinsics fill "len" bytes of memory starting
5557 at the destination location. If the argument is known to be aligned to some
5558 boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument, otherwise it should
5559 be set to 0 or 1.</p>
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005560
Chris Lattner10610642004-02-14 04:08:35 +00005561</div>
5562
Chris Lattner32006282004-06-11 02:28:03 +00005563<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5564<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005565 <a name="int_sqrt">'<tt>llvm.sqrt.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattnera4d74142005-07-21 01:29:16 +00005566</div>
5567
5568<div class="doc_text">
5569
5570<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005571<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.sqrt</tt> on any
5572 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support all
5573 types however.</p>
5574
Chris Lattnera4d74142005-07-21 01:29:16 +00005575<pre>
Dale Johannesen408f9c12007-10-02 17:47:38 +00005576 declare float @llvm.sqrt.f32(float %Val)
5577 declare double @llvm.sqrt.f64(double %Val)
5578 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sqrt.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
5579 declare fp128 @llvm.sqrt.f128(fp128 %Val)
5580 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sqrt.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Chris Lattnera4d74142005-07-21 01:29:16 +00005581</pre>
5582
5583<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005584<p>The '<tt>llvm.sqrt</tt>' intrinsics return the sqrt of the specified operand,
5585 returning the same value as the libm '<tt>sqrt</tt>' functions would.
5586 Unlike <tt>sqrt</tt> in libm, however, <tt>llvm.sqrt</tt> has undefined
5587 behavior for negative numbers other than -0.0 (which allows for better
5588 optimization, because there is no need to worry about errno being
5589 set). <tt>llvm.sqrt(-0.0)</tt> is defined to return -0.0 like IEEE sqrt.</p>
Chris Lattnera4d74142005-07-21 01:29:16 +00005590
5591<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005592<p>The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
5593 type.</p>
Chris Lattnera4d74142005-07-21 01:29:16 +00005594
5595<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005596<p>This function returns the sqrt of the specified operand if it is a
5597 nonnegative floating point number.</p>
Chris Lattnera4d74142005-07-21 01:29:16 +00005598
Chris Lattnera4d74142005-07-21 01:29:16 +00005599</div>
5600
Chris Lattnerf4d252d2006-09-08 06:34:02 +00005601<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5602<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005603 <a name="int_powi">'<tt>llvm.powi.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattnerf4d252d2006-09-08 06:34:02 +00005604</div>
5605
5606<div class="doc_text">
5607
5608<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005609<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.powi</tt> on any
5610 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support all
5611 types however.</p>
5612
Chris Lattnerf4d252d2006-09-08 06:34:02 +00005613<pre>
Dale Johannesen408f9c12007-10-02 17:47:38 +00005614 declare float @llvm.powi.f32(float %Val, i32 %power)
5615 declare double @llvm.powi.f64(double %Val, i32 %power)
5616 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.powi.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, i32 %power)
5617 declare fp128 @llvm.powi.f128(fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
5618 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.powi.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
Chris Lattnerf4d252d2006-09-08 06:34:02 +00005619</pre>
5620
5621<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005622<p>The '<tt>llvm.powi.*</tt>' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
5623 specified (positive or negative) power. The order of evaluation of
5624 multiplications is not defined. When a vector of floating point type is
5625 used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.</p>
Chris Lattnerf4d252d2006-09-08 06:34:02 +00005626
5627<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005628<p>The second argument is an integer power, and the first is a value to raise to
5629 that power.</p>
Chris Lattnerf4d252d2006-09-08 06:34:02 +00005630
5631<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005632<p>This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
5633 unspecified sequence of rounding operations.</p>
Chris Lattnerf4d252d2006-09-08 06:34:02 +00005634
Chris Lattnerf4d252d2006-09-08 06:34:02 +00005635</div>
5636
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005637<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5638<div class="doc_subsubsection">
5639 <a name="int_sin">'<tt>llvm.sin.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
5640</div>
5641
5642<div class="doc_text">
5643
5644<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005645<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.sin</tt> on any
5646 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support all
5647 types however.</p>
5648
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005649<pre>
5650 declare float @llvm.sin.f32(float %Val)
5651 declare double @llvm.sin.f64(double %Val)
5652 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sin.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
5653 declare fp128 @llvm.sin.f128(fp128 %Val)
5654 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sin.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
5655</pre>
5656
5657<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005658<p>The '<tt>llvm.sin.*</tt>' intrinsics return the sine of the operand.</p>
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005659
5660<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005661<p>The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
5662 type.</p>
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005663
5664<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005665<p>This function returns the sine of the specified operand, returning the same
5666 values as the libm <tt>sin</tt> functions would, and handles error conditions
5667 in the same way.</p>
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005668
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005669</div>
5670
5671<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5672<div class="doc_subsubsection">
5673 <a name="int_cos">'<tt>llvm.cos.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
5674</div>
5675
5676<div class="doc_text">
5677
5678<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005679<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.cos</tt> on any
5680 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support all
5681 types however.</p>
5682
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005683<pre>
5684 declare float @llvm.cos.f32(float %Val)
5685 declare double @llvm.cos.f64(double %Val)
5686 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.cos.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
5687 declare fp128 @llvm.cos.f128(fp128 %Val)
5688 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.cos.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
5689</pre>
5690
5691<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005692<p>The '<tt>llvm.cos.*</tt>' intrinsics return the cosine of the operand.</p>
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005693
5694<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005695<p>The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
5696 type.</p>
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005697
5698<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005699<p>This function returns the cosine of the specified operand, returning the same
5700 values as the libm <tt>cos</tt> functions would, and handles error conditions
5701 in the same way.</p>
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005702
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005703</div>
5704
5705<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5706<div class="doc_subsubsection">
5707 <a name="int_pow">'<tt>llvm.pow.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
5708</div>
5709
5710<div class="doc_text">
5711
5712<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005713<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.pow</tt> on any
5714 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support all
5715 types however.</p>
5716
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005717<pre>
5718 declare float @llvm.pow.f32(float %Val, float %Power)
5719 declare double @llvm.pow.f64(double %Val, double %Power)
5720 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.pow.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, x86_fp80 %Power)
5721 declare fp128 @llvm.pow.f128(fp128 %Val, fp128 %Power)
5722 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.pow.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, ppc_fp128 Power)
5723</pre>
5724
5725<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005726<p>The '<tt>llvm.pow.*</tt>' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
5727 specified (positive or negative) power.</p>
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005728
5729<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005730<p>The second argument is a floating point power, and the first is a value to
5731 raise to that power.</p>
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005732
5733<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005734<p>This function returns the first value raised to the second power, returning
5735 the same values as the libm <tt>pow</tt> functions would, and handles error
5736 conditions in the same way.</p>
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005737
Dan Gohman91c284c2007-10-15 20:30:11 +00005738</div>
5739
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005740<!-- ======================================================================= -->
5741<div class="doc_subsection">
Nate Begeman7e36c472006-01-13 23:26:38 +00005742 <a name="int_manip">Bit Manipulation Intrinsics</a>
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005743</div>
5744
5745<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005746
5747<p>LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important bit manipulation operations.
5748 These allow efficient code generation for some algorithms.</p>
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005749
5750</div>
5751
5752<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5753<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencera3e435f2007-04-04 02:42:35 +00005754 <a name="int_bswap">'<tt>llvm.bswap.*</tt>' Intrinsics</a>
Nate Begeman7e36c472006-01-13 23:26:38 +00005755</div>
5756
5757<div class="doc_text">
5758
5759<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Reid Spencer409e28f2007-04-01 08:04:23 +00005760<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bswap on any integer
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005761 type that is an even number of bytes (i.e. BitWidth % 16 == 0).</p>
5762
Nate Begeman7e36c472006-01-13 23:26:38 +00005763<pre>
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00005764 declare i16 @llvm.bswap.i16(i16 &lt;id&gt;)
5765 declare i32 @llvm.bswap.i32(i32 &lt;id&gt;)
5766 declare i64 @llvm.bswap.i64(i64 &lt;id&gt;)
Nate Begeman7e36c472006-01-13 23:26:38 +00005767</pre>
5768
5769<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005770<p>The '<tt>llvm.bswap</tt>' family of intrinsics is used to byte swap integer
5771 values with an even number of bytes (positive multiple of 16 bits). These
5772 are useful for performing operations on data that is not in the target's
5773 native byte order.</p>
Nate Begeman7e36c472006-01-13 23:26:38 +00005774
5775<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005776<p>The <tt>llvm.bswap.i16</tt> intrinsic returns an i16 value that has the high
5777 and low byte of the input i16 swapped. Similarly,
5778 the <tt>llvm.bswap.i32</tt> intrinsic returns an i32 value that has the four
5779 bytes of the input i32 swapped, so that if the input bytes are numbered 0, 1,
5780 2, 3 then the returned i32 will have its bytes in 3, 2, 1, 0 order.
5781 The <tt>llvm.bswap.i48</tt>, <tt>llvm.bswap.i64</tt> and other intrinsics
5782 extend this concept to additional even-byte lengths (6 bytes, 8 bytes and
5783 more, respectively).</p>
Nate Begeman7e36c472006-01-13 23:26:38 +00005784
5785</div>
5786
5787<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5788<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Reid Spencer0b118202006-01-16 21:12:35 +00005789 <a name="int_ctpop">'<tt>llvm.ctpop.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005790</div>
5791
5792<div class="doc_text">
5793
5794<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Reid Spencer409e28f2007-04-01 08:04:23 +00005795<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ctpop on any integer bit
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005796 width. Not all targets support all bit widths however.</p>
5797
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005798<pre>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005799 declare i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 &lt;src&gt;)
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00005800 declare i16 @llvm.ctpop.i16(i16 &lt;src&gt;)
Anton Korobeynikovec43a062007-03-22 00:02:17 +00005801 declare i32 @llvm.ctpop.i32(i32 &lt;src&gt;)
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00005802 declare i64 @llvm.ctpop.i64(i64 &lt;src&gt;)
5803 declare i256 @llvm.ctpop.i256(i256 &lt;src&gt;)
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005804</pre>
5805
5806<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005807<p>The '<tt>llvm.ctpop</tt>' family of intrinsics counts the number of bits set
5808 in a value.</p>
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005809
5810<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005811<p>The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any
5812 integer type. The return type must match the argument type.</p>
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005813
5814<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005815<p>The '<tt>llvm.ctpop</tt>' intrinsic counts the 1's in a variable.</p>
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005816
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005817</div>
5818
5819<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5820<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Chris Lattner8a886be2006-01-16 22:34:14 +00005821 <a name="int_ctlz">'<tt>llvm.ctlz.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005822</div>
5823
5824<div class="doc_text">
5825
5826<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005827<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.ctlz</tt> on any
5828 integer bit width. Not all targets support all bit widths however.</p>
5829
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005830<pre>
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00005831 declare i8 @llvm.ctlz.i8 (i8 &lt;src&gt;)
5832 declare i16 @llvm.ctlz.i16(i16 &lt;src&gt;)
Anton Korobeynikovec43a062007-03-22 00:02:17 +00005833 declare i32 @llvm.ctlz.i32(i32 &lt;src&gt;)
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00005834 declare i64 @llvm.ctlz.i64(i64 &lt;src&gt;)
5835 declare i256 @llvm.ctlz.i256(i256 &lt;src&gt;)
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005836</pre>
5837
5838<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005839<p>The '<tt>llvm.ctlz</tt>' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
5840 leading zeros in a variable.</p>
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005841
5842<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005843<p>The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any
5844 integer type. The return type must match the argument type.</p>
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005845
5846<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005847<p>The '<tt>llvm.ctlz</tt>' intrinsic counts the leading (most significant)
5848 zeros in a variable. If the src == 0 then the result is the size in bits of
5849 the type of src. For example, <tt>llvm.ctlz(i32 2) = 30</tt>.</p>
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005850
Andrew Lenharthec370fd2005-05-03 18:01:48 +00005851</div>
Chris Lattner32006282004-06-11 02:28:03 +00005852
Chris Lattnereff29ab2005-05-15 19:39:26 +00005853<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5854<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Chris Lattner8a886be2006-01-16 22:34:14 +00005855 <a name="int_cttz">'<tt>llvm.cttz.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Chris Lattnereff29ab2005-05-15 19:39:26 +00005856</div>
5857
5858<div class="doc_text">
5859
5860<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005861<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.cttz</tt> on any
5862 integer bit width. Not all targets support all bit widths however.</p>
5863
Chris Lattnereff29ab2005-05-15 19:39:26 +00005864<pre>
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00005865 declare i8 @llvm.cttz.i8 (i8 &lt;src&gt;)
5866 declare i16 @llvm.cttz.i16(i16 &lt;src&gt;)
Anton Korobeynikovec43a062007-03-22 00:02:17 +00005867 declare i32 @llvm.cttz.i32(i32 &lt;src&gt;)
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00005868 declare i64 @llvm.cttz.i64(i64 &lt;src&gt;)
5869 declare i256 @llvm.cttz.i256(i256 &lt;src&gt;)
Chris Lattnereff29ab2005-05-15 19:39:26 +00005870</pre>
5871
5872<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005873<p>The '<tt>llvm.cttz</tt>' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
5874 trailing zeros.</p>
Chris Lattnereff29ab2005-05-15 19:39:26 +00005875
5876<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005877<p>The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any
5878 integer type. The return type must match the argument type.</p>
Chris Lattnereff29ab2005-05-15 19:39:26 +00005879
5880<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005881<p>The '<tt>llvm.cttz</tt>' intrinsic counts the trailing (least significant)
5882 zeros in a variable. If the src == 0 then the result is the size in bits of
5883 the type of src. For example, <tt>llvm.cttz(2) = 1</tt>.</p>
Chris Lattnereff29ab2005-05-15 19:39:26 +00005884
Chris Lattnereff29ab2005-05-15 19:39:26 +00005885</div>
5886
Bill Wendlingda01af72009-02-08 04:04:40 +00005887<!-- ======================================================================= -->
5888<div class="doc_subsection">
5889 <a name="int_overflow">Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics</a>
5890</div>
5891
5892<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005893
5894<p>LLVM provides intrinsics for some arithmetic with overflow operations.</p>
Bill Wendlingda01af72009-02-08 04:04:40 +00005895
5896</div>
5897
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005898<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5899<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Bill Wendlingda01af72009-02-08 04:04:40 +00005900 <a name="int_sadd_overflow">'<tt>llvm.sadd.with.overflow.*</tt>' Intrinsics</a>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005901</div>
5902
5903<div class="doc_text">
5904
5905<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005906<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.sadd.with.overflow</tt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005907 on any integer bit width.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005908
5909<pre>
5910 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
5911 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
5912 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
5913</pre>
5914
5915<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005916<p>The '<tt>llvm.sadd.with.overflow</tt>' family of intrinsic functions perform
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005917 a signed addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether an overflow
5918 occurred during the signed summation.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005919
5920<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005921<p>The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure may
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005922 be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same bit
5923 width. The second element of the result structure must be of
5924 type <tt>i1</tt>. <tt>%a</tt> and <tt>%b</tt> are the two values that will
5925 undergo signed addition.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005926
5927<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005928<p>The '<tt>llvm.sadd.with.overflow</tt>' family of intrinsic functions perform
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005929 a signed addition of the two variables. They return a structure &mdash; the
5930 first element of which is the signed summation, and the second element of
5931 which is a bit specifying if the signed summation resulted in an
5932 overflow.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005933
5934<h5>Examples:</h5>
5935<pre>
5936 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
5937 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
5938 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
5939 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
5940</pre>
5941
5942</div>
5943
5944<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5945<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Bill Wendlingda01af72009-02-08 04:04:40 +00005946 <a name="int_uadd_overflow">'<tt>llvm.uadd.with.overflow.*</tt>' Intrinsics</a>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005947</div>
5948
5949<div class="doc_text">
5950
5951<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005952<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.uadd.with.overflow</tt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005953 on any integer bit width.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005954
5955<pre>
5956 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
5957 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
5958 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
5959</pre>
5960
5961<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005962<p>The '<tt>llvm.uadd.with.overflow</tt>' family of intrinsic functions perform
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005963 an unsigned addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether a carry
5964 occurred during the unsigned summation.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005965
5966<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005967<p>The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure may
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005968 be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same bit
5969 width. The second element of the result structure must be of
5970 type <tt>i1</tt>. <tt>%a</tt> and <tt>%b</tt> are the two values that will
5971 undergo unsigned addition.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005972
5973<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005974<p>The '<tt>llvm.uadd.with.overflow</tt>' family of intrinsic functions perform
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005975 an unsigned addition of the two arguments. They return a structure &mdash;
5976 the first element of which is the sum, and the second element of which is a
5977 bit specifying if the unsigned summation resulted in a carry.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005978
5979<h5>Examples:</h5>
5980<pre>
5981 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
5982 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
5983 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
5984 br i1 %obit, label %carry, label %normal
5985</pre>
5986
5987</div>
5988
5989<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
5990<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Bill Wendlingda01af72009-02-08 04:04:40 +00005991 <a name="int_ssub_overflow">'<tt>llvm.ssub.with.overflow.*</tt>' Intrinsics</a>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005992</div>
5993
5994<div class="doc_text">
5995
5996<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005997<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.ssub.with.overflow</tt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00005998 on any integer bit width.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00005999
6000<pre>
6001 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
6002 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
6003 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
6004</pre>
6005
6006<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006007<p>The '<tt>llvm.ssub.with.overflow</tt>' family of intrinsic functions perform
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006008 a signed subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an overflow
6009 occurred during the signed subtraction.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006010
6011<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006012<p>The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure may
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006013 be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same bit
6014 width. The second element of the result structure must be of
6015 type <tt>i1</tt>. <tt>%a</tt> and <tt>%b</tt> are the two values that will
6016 undergo signed subtraction.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006017
6018<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006019<p>The '<tt>llvm.ssub.with.overflow</tt>' family of intrinsic functions perform
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006020 a signed subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure &mdash;
6021 the first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
6022 which is a bit specifying if the signed subtraction resulted in an
6023 overflow.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006024
6025<h5>Examples:</h5>
6026<pre>
6027 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
6028 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
6029 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
6030 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
6031</pre>
6032
6033</div>
6034
6035<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6036<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Bill Wendlingda01af72009-02-08 04:04:40 +00006037 <a name="int_usub_overflow">'<tt>llvm.usub.with.overflow.*</tt>' Intrinsics</a>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006038</div>
6039
6040<div class="doc_text">
6041
6042<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006043<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.usub.with.overflow</tt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006044 on any integer bit width.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006045
6046<pre>
6047 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
6048 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
6049 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
6050</pre>
6051
6052<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006053<p>The '<tt>llvm.usub.with.overflow</tt>' family of intrinsic functions perform
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006054 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
6055 overflow occurred during the unsigned subtraction.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006056
6057<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006058<p>The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure may
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006059 be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same bit
6060 width. The second element of the result structure must be of
6061 type <tt>i1</tt>. <tt>%a</tt> and <tt>%b</tt> are the two values that will
6062 undergo unsigned subtraction.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006063
6064<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006065<p>The '<tt>llvm.usub.with.overflow</tt>' family of intrinsic functions perform
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006066 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure &mdash;
6067 the first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
6068 which is a bit specifying if the unsigned subtraction resulted in an
6069 overflow.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006070
6071<h5>Examples:</h5>
6072<pre>
6073 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
6074 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
6075 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
6076 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
6077</pre>
6078
6079</div>
6080
6081<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6082<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Bill Wendlingda01af72009-02-08 04:04:40 +00006083 <a name="int_smul_overflow">'<tt>llvm.smul.with.overflow.*</tt>' Intrinsics</a>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006084</div>
6085
6086<div class="doc_text">
6087
6088<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006089<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.smul.with.overflow</tt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006090 on any integer bit width.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006091
6092<pre>
6093 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
6094 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
6095 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
6096</pre>
6097
6098<h5>Overview:</h5>
6099
6100<p>The '<tt>llvm.smul.with.overflow</tt>' family of intrinsic functions perform
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006101 a signed multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
6102 overflow occurred during the signed multiplication.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006103
6104<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006105<p>The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure may
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006106 be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same bit
6107 width. The second element of the result structure must be of
6108 type <tt>i1</tt>. <tt>%a</tt> and <tt>%b</tt> are the two values that will
6109 undergo signed multiplication.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006110
6111<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006112<p>The '<tt>llvm.smul.with.overflow</tt>' family of intrinsic functions perform
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006113 a signed multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure &mdash;
6114 the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second element of
6115 which is a bit specifying if the signed multiplication resulted in an
6116 overflow.</p>
Bill Wendlingac1df8e2009-02-08 01:40:31 +00006117
6118<h5>Examples:</h5>
6119<pre>
6120 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
6121 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
6122 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
6123 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
6124</pre>
6125
Reid Spencerf86037f2007-04-11 23:23:49 +00006126</div>
6127
Bill Wendling41b485c2009-02-08 23:00:09 +00006128<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6129<div class="doc_subsubsection">
6130 <a name="int_umul_overflow">'<tt>llvm.umul.with.overflow.*</tt>' Intrinsics</a>
6131</div>
6132
6133<div class="doc_text">
6134
6135<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendling41b485c2009-02-08 23:00:09 +00006136<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.umul.with.overflow</tt>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006137 on any integer bit width.</p>
Bill Wendling41b485c2009-02-08 23:00:09 +00006138
6139<pre>
6140 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
6141 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
6142 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
6143</pre>
6144
6145<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendling41b485c2009-02-08 23:00:09 +00006146<p>The '<tt>llvm.umul.with.overflow</tt>' family of intrinsic functions perform
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006147 a unsigned multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
6148 overflow occurred during the unsigned multiplication.</p>
Bill Wendling41b485c2009-02-08 23:00:09 +00006149
6150<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendling41b485c2009-02-08 23:00:09 +00006151<p>The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure may
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006152 be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same bit
6153 width. The second element of the result structure must be of
6154 type <tt>i1</tt>. <tt>%a</tt> and <tt>%b</tt> are the two values that will
6155 undergo unsigned multiplication.</p>
Bill Wendling41b485c2009-02-08 23:00:09 +00006156
6157<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendling41b485c2009-02-08 23:00:09 +00006158<p>The '<tt>llvm.umul.with.overflow</tt>' family of intrinsic functions perform
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006159 an unsigned multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure
6160 &mdash; the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second
6161 element of which is a bit specifying if the unsigned multiplication resulted
6162 in an overflow.</p>
Bill Wendling41b485c2009-02-08 23:00:09 +00006163
6164<h5>Examples:</h5>
6165<pre>
6166 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
6167 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
6168 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
6169 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
6170</pre>
6171
6172</div>
6173
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00006174<!-- ======================================================================= -->
6175<div class="doc_subsection">
6176 <a name="int_debugger">Debugger Intrinsics</a>
6177</div>
6178
6179<div class="doc_text">
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00006180
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006181<p>The LLVM debugger intrinsics (which all start with <tt>llvm.dbg.</tt>
6182 prefix), are described in
6183 the <a href="SourceLevelDebugging.html#format_common_intrinsics">LLVM Source
6184 Level Debugging</a> document.</p>
6185
6186</div>
Chris Lattner8ff75902004-01-06 05:31:32 +00006187
Jim Laskeydd4ef1b2007-03-14 19:31:19 +00006188<!-- ======================================================================= -->
6189<div class="doc_subsection">
6190 <a name="int_eh">Exception Handling Intrinsics</a>
6191</div>
6192
6193<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006194
6195<p>The LLVM exception handling intrinsics (which all start with
6196 <tt>llvm.eh.</tt> prefix), are described in
6197 the <a href="ExceptionHandling.html#format_common_intrinsics">LLVM Exception
6198 Handling</a> document.</p>
6199
Jim Laskeydd4ef1b2007-03-14 19:31:19 +00006200</div>
6201
Tanya Lattner6d806e92007-06-15 20:50:54 +00006202<!-- ======================================================================= -->
6203<div class="doc_subsection">
Duncan Sandsf7331b32007-09-11 14:10:23 +00006204 <a name="int_trampoline">Trampoline Intrinsic</a>
Duncan Sands36397f52007-07-27 12:58:54 +00006205</div>
6206
6207<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006208
6209<p>This intrinsic makes it possible to excise one parameter, marked with
6210 the <tt>nest</tt> attribute, from a function. The result is a callable
6211 function pointer lacking the nest parameter - the caller does not need to
6212 provide a value for it. Instead, the value to use is stored in advance in a
6213 "trampoline", a block of memory usually allocated on the stack, which also
6214 contains code to splice the nest value into the argument list. This is used
6215 to implement the GCC nested function address extension.</p>
6216
6217<p>For example, if the function is
6218 <tt>i32 f(i8* nest %c, i32 %x, i32 %y)</tt> then the resulting function
6219 pointer has signature <tt>i32 (i32, i32)*</tt>. It can be created as
6220 follows:</p>
6221
6222<div class="doc_code">
Duncan Sands36397f52007-07-27 12:58:54 +00006223<pre>
Duncan Sandsf7331b32007-09-11 14:10:23 +00006224 %tramp = alloca [10 x i8], align 4 ; size and alignment only correct for X86
6225 %tramp1 = getelementptr [10 x i8]* %tramp, i32 0, i32 0
6226 %p = call i8* @llvm.init.trampoline( i8* %tramp1, i8* bitcast (i32 (i8* nest , i32, i32)* @f to i8*), i8* %nval )
6227 %fp = bitcast i8* %p to i32 (i32, i32)*
Duncan Sands36397f52007-07-27 12:58:54 +00006228</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006229</div>
6230
6231<p>The call <tt>%val = call i32 %fp( i32 %x, i32 %y )</tt> is then equivalent
6232 to <tt>%val = call i32 %f( i8* %nval, i32 %x, i32 %y )</tt>.</p>
6233
Duncan Sands36397f52007-07-27 12:58:54 +00006234</div>
6235
6236<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6237<div class="doc_subsubsection">
6238 <a name="int_it">'<tt>llvm.init.trampoline</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
6239</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006240
Duncan Sands36397f52007-07-27 12:58:54 +00006241<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006242
Duncan Sands36397f52007-07-27 12:58:54 +00006243<h5>Syntax:</h5>
6244<pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006245 declare i8* @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* &lt;tramp&gt;, i8* &lt;func&gt;, i8* &lt;nval&gt;)
Duncan Sands36397f52007-07-27 12:58:54 +00006246</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006247
Duncan Sands36397f52007-07-27 12:58:54 +00006248<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006249<p>This fills the memory pointed to by <tt>tramp</tt> with code and returns a
6250 function pointer suitable for executing it.</p>
6251
Duncan Sands36397f52007-07-27 12:58:54 +00006252<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006253<p>The <tt>llvm.init.trampoline</tt> intrinsic takes three arguments, all
6254 pointers. The <tt>tramp</tt> argument must point to a sufficiently large and
6255 sufficiently aligned block of memory; this memory is written to by the
6256 intrinsic. Note that the size and the alignment are target-specific - LLVM
6257 currently provides no portable way of determining them, so a front-end that
6258 generates this intrinsic needs to have some target-specific knowledge.
6259 The <tt>func</tt> argument must hold a function bitcast to
6260 an <tt>i8*</tt>.</p>
6261
Duncan Sands36397f52007-07-27 12:58:54 +00006262<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006263<p>The block of memory pointed to by <tt>tramp</tt> is filled with target
6264 dependent code, turning it into a function. A pointer to this function is
6265 returned, but needs to be bitcast to an <a href="#int_trampoline">appropriate
6266 function pointer type</a> before being called. The new function's signature
6267 is the same as that of <tt>func</tt> with any arguments marked with
6268 the <tt>nest</tt> attribute removed. At most one such <tt>nest</tt> argument
6269 is allowed, and it must be of pointer type. Calling the new function is
6270 equivalent to calling <tt>func</tt> with the same argument list, but
6271 with <tt>nval</tt> used for the missing <tt>nest</tt> argument. If, after
6272 calling <tt>llvm.init.trampoline</tt>, the memory pointed to
6273 by <tt>tramp</tt> is modified, then the effect of any later call to the
6274 returned function pointer is undefined.</p>
6275
Duncan Sands36397f52007-07-27 12:58:54 +00006276</div>
6277
6278<!-- ======================================================================= -->
6279<div class="doc_subsection">
Andrew Lenharth22c5c1b2008-02-16 01:24:58 +00006280 <a name="int_atomics">Atomic Operations and Synchronization Intrinsics</a>
6281</div>
6282
6283<div class="doc_text">
Andrew Lenharth22c5c1b2008-02-16 01:24:58 +00006284
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006285<p>These intrinsic functions expand the "universal IR" of LLVM to represent
6286 hardware constructs for atomic operations and memory synchronization. This
6287 provides an interface to the hardware, not an interface to the programmer. It
6288 is aimed at a low enough level to allow any programming models or APIs
6289 (Application Programming Interfaces) which need atomic behaviors to map
6290 cleanly onto it. It is also modeled primarily on hardware behavior. Just as
6291 hardware provides a "universal IR" for source languages, it also provides a
6292 starting point for developing a "universal" atomic operation and
6293 synchronization IR.</p>
6294
6295<p>These do <em>not</em> form an API such as high-level threading libraries,
6296 software transaction memory systems, atomic primitives, and intrinsic
6297 functions as found in BSD, GNU libc, atomic_ops, APR, and other system and
6298 application libraries. The hardware interface provided by LLVM should allow
6299 a clean implementation of all of these APIs and parallel programming models.
6300 No one model or paradigm should be selected above others unless the hardware
6301 itself ubiquitously does so.</p>
6302
Andrew Lenharth22c5c1b2008-02-16 01:24:58 +00006303</div>
6304
6305<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6306<div class="doc_subsubsection">
6307 <a name="int_memory_barrier">'<tt>llvm.memory.barrier</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
6308</div>
6309<div class="doc_text">
6310<h5>Syntax:</h5>
6311<pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006312 declare void @llvm.memory.barrier( i1 &lt;ll&gt;, i1 &lt;ls&gt;, i1 &lt;sl&gt;, i1 &lt;ss&gt;, i1 &lt;device&gt; )
Andrew Lenharth22c5c1b2008-02-16 01:24:58 +00006313</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006314
Andrew Lenharth22c5c1b2008-02-16 01:24:58 +00006315<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006316<p>The <tt>llvm.memory.barrier</tt> intrinsic guarantees ordering between
6317 specific pairs of memory access types.</p>
6318
Andrew Lenharth22c5c1b2008-02-16 01:24:58 +00006319<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006320<p>The <tt>llvm.memory.barrier</tt> intrinsic requires five boolean arguments.
6321 The first four arguments enables a specific barrier as listed below. The
6322 fith argument specifies that the barrier applies to io or device or uncached
6323 memory.</p>
Andrew Lenharth22c5c1b2008-02-16 01:24:58 +00006324
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006325<ul>
6326 <li><tt>ll</tt>: load-load barrier</li>
6327 <li><tt>ls</tt>: load-store barrier</li>
6328 <li><tt>sl</tt>: store-load barrier</li>
6329 <li><tt>ss</tt>: store-store barrier</li>
6330 <li><tt>device</tt>: barrier applies to device and uncached memory also.</li>
6331</ul>
6332
Andrew Lenharth22c5c1b2008-02-16 01:24:58 +00006333<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006334<p>This intrinsic causes the system to enforce some ordering constraints upon
6335 the loads and stores of the program. This barrier does not
6336 indicate <em>when</em> any events will occur, it only enforces
6337 an <em>order</em> in which they occur. For any of the specified pairs of load
6338 and store operations (f.ex. load-load, or store-load), all of the first
6339 operations preceding the barrier will complete before any of the second
6340 operations succeeding the barrier begin. Specifically the semantics for each
6341 pairing is as follows:</p>
Andrew Lenharth22c5c1b2008-02-16 01:24:58 +00006342
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006343<ul>
6344 <li><tt>ll</tt>: All loads before the barrier must complete before any load
6345 after the barrier begins.</li>
6346 <li><tt>ls</tt>: All loads before the barrier must complete before any
6347 store after the barrier begins.</li>
6348 <li><tt>ss</tt>: All stores before the barrier must complete before any
6349 store after the barrier begins.</li>
6350 <li><tt>sl</tt>: All stores before the barrier must complete before any
6351 load after the barrier begins.</li>
6352</ul>
6353
6354<p>These semantics are applied with a logical "and" behavior when more than one
6355 is enabled in a single memory barrier intrinsic.</p>
6356
6357<p>Backends may implement stronger barriers than those requested when they do
6358 not support as fine grained a barrier as requested. Some architectures do
6359 not need all types of barriers and on such architectures, these become
6360 noops.</p>
6361
Andrew Lenharth22c5c1b2008-02-16 01:24:58 +00006362<h5>Example:</h5>
6363<pre>
6364%ptr = malloc i32
6365 store i32 4, %ptr
6366
6367%result1 = load i32* %ptr <i>; yields {i32}:result1 = 4</i>
6368 call void @llvm.memory.barrier( i1 false, i1 true, i1 false, i1 false )
6369 <i>; guarantee the above finishes</i>
6370 store i32 8, %ptr <i>; before this begins</i>
6371</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006372
Andrew Lenharth22c5c1b2008-02-16 01:24:58 +00006373</div>
6374
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006375<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6376<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006377 <a name="int_atomic_cmp_swap">'<tt>llvm.atomic.cmp.swap.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006378</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006379
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006380<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006381
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006382<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006383<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.atomic.cmp.swap</tt> on
6384 any integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
6385 support all bit widths however.</p>
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006386
6387<pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006388 declare i8 @llvm.atomic.cmp.swap.i8.p0i8( i8* &lt;ptr&gt;, i8 &lt;cmp&gt;, i8 &lt;val&gt; )
6389 declare i16 @llvm.atomic.cmp.swap.i16.p0i16( i16* &lt;ptr&gt;, i16 &lt;cmp&gt;, i16 &lt;val&gt; )
6390 declare i32 @llvm.atomic.cmp.swap.i32.p0i32( i32* &lt;ptr&gt;, i32 &lt;cmp&gt;, i32 &lt;val&gt; )
6391 declare i64 @llvm.atomic.cmp.swap.i64.p0i64( i64* &lt;ptr&gt;, i64 &lt;cmp&gt;, i64 &lt;val&gt; )
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006392</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006393
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006394<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006395<p>This loads a value in memory and compares it to a given value. If they are
6396 equal, it stores a new value into the memory.</p>
6397
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006398<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006399<p>The <tt>llvm.atomic.cmp.swap</tt> intrinsic takes three arguments. The result
6400 as well as both <tt>cmp</tt> and <tt>val</tt> must be integer values with the
6401 same bit width. The <tt>ptr</tt> argument must be a pointer to a value of
6402 this integer type. While any bit width integer may be used, targets may only
6403 lower representations they support in hardware.</p>
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006404
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006405<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006406<p>This entire intrinsic must be executed atomically. It first loads the value
6407 in memory pointed to by <tt>ptr</tt> and compares it with the
6408 value <tt>cmp</tt>. If they are equal, <tt>val</tt> is stored into the
6409 memory. The loaded value is yielded in all cases. This provides the
6410 equivalent of an atomic compare-and-swap operation within the SSA
6411 framework.</p>
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006412
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006413<h5>Examples:</h5>
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006414<pre>
6415%ptr = malloc i32
6416 store i32 4, %ptr
6417
6418%val1 = add i32 4, 4
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006419%result1 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.cmp.swap.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 4, %val1 )
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006420 <i>; yields {i32}:result1 = 4</i>
6421%stored1 = icmp eq i32 %result1, 4 <i>; yields {i1}:stored1 = true</i>
6422%memval1 = load i32* %ptr <i>; yields {i32}:memval1 = 8</i>
6423
6424%val2 = add i32 1, 1
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006425%result2 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.cmp.swap.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 5, %val2 )
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006426 <i>; yields {i32}:result2 = 8</i>
6427%stored2 = icmp eq i32 %result2, 5 <i>; yields {i1}:stored2 = false</i>
6428
6429%memval2 = load i32* %ptr <i>; yields {i32}:memval2 = 8</i>
6430</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006431
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006432</div>
6433
6434<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6435<div class="doc_subsubsection">
6436 <a name="int_atomic_swap">'<tt>llvm.atomic.swap.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
6437</div>
6438<div class="doc_text">
6439<h5>Syntax:</h5>
6440
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006441<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.atomic.swap</tt> on any
6442 integer bit width. Not all targets support all bit widths however.</p>
6443
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006444<pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006445 declare i8 @llvm.atomic.swap.i8.p0i8( i8* &lt;ptr&gt;, i8 &lt;val&gt; )
6446 declare i16 @llvm.atomic.swap.i16.p0i16( i16* &lt;ptr&gt;, i16 &lt;val&gt; )
6447 declare i32 @llvm.atomic.swap.i32.p0i32( i32* &lt;ptr&gt;, i32 &lt;val&gt; )
6448 declare i64 @llvm.atomic.swap.i64.p0i64( i64* &lt;ptr&gt;, i64 &lt;val&gt; )
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006449</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006450
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006451<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006452<p>This intrinsic loads the value stored in memory at <tt>ptr</tt> and yields
6453 the value from memory. It then stores the value in <tt>val</tt> in the memory
6454 at <tt>ptr</tt>.</p>
6455
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006456<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006457<p>The <tt>llvm.atomic.swap</tt> intrinsic takes two arguments. Both
6458 the <tt>val</tt> argument and the result must be integers of the same bit
6459 width. The first argument, <tt>ptr</tt>, must be a pointer to a value of this
6460 integer type. The targets may only lower integer representations they
6461 support.</p>
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006462
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006463<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006464<p>This intrinsic loads the value pointed to by <tt>ptr</tt>, yields it, and
6465 stores <tt>val</tt> back into <tt>ptr</tt> atomically. This provides the
6466 equivalent of an atomic swap operation within the SSA framework.</p>
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006467
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006468<h5>Examples:</h5>
6469<pre>
6470%ptr = malloc i32
6471 store i32 4, %ptr
6472
6473%val1 = add i32 4, 4
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006474%result1 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.swap.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 %val1 )
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006475 <i>; yields {i32}:result1 = 4</i>
6476%stored1 = icmp eq i32 %result1, 4 <i>; yields {i1}:stored1 = true</i>
6477%memval1 = load i32* %ptr <i>; yields {i32}:memval1 = 8</i>
6478
6479%val2 = add i32 1, 1
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006480%result2 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.swap.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 %val2 )
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006481 <i>; yields {i32}:result2 = 8</i>
6482
6483%stored2 = icmp eq i32 %result2, 8 <i>; yields {i1}:stored2 = true</i>
6484%memval2 = load i32* %ptr <i>; yields {i32}:memval2 = 2</i>
6485</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006486
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006487</div>
6488
6489<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6490<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006491 <a name="int_atomic_load_add">'<tt>llvm.atomic.load.add.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006492
6493</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006494
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006495<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006496
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006497<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006498<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.atomic.load.add</tt> on
6499 any integer bit width. Not all targets support all bit widths however.</p>
6500
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006501<pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006502 declare i8 @llvm.atomic.load.add.i8..p0i8( i8* &lt;ptr&gt;, i8 &lt;delta&gt; )
6503 declare i16 @llvm.atomic.load.add.i16..p0i16( i16* &lt;ptr&gt;, i16 &lt;delta&gt; )
6504 declare i32 @llvm.atomic.load.add.i32..p0i32( i32* &lt;ptr&gt;, i32 &lt;delta&gt; )
6505 declare i64 @llvm.atomic.load.add.i64..p0i64( i64* &lt;ptr&gt;, i64 &lt;delta&gt; )
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006506</pre>
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006507
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006508<h5>Overview:</h5>
6509<p>This intrinsic adds <tt>delta</tt> to the value stored in memory
6510 at <tt>ptr</tt>. It yields the original value at <tt>ptr</tt>.</p>
6511
6512<h5>Arguments:</h5>
6513<p>The intrinsic takes two arguments, the first a pointer to an integer value
6514 and the second an integer value. The result is also an integer value. These
6515 integer types can have any bit width, but they must all have the same bit
6516 width. The targets may only lower integer representations they support.</p>
6517
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006518<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006519<p>This intrinsic does a series of operations atomically. It first loads the
6520 value stored at <tt>ptr</tt>. It then adds <tt>delta</tt>, stores the result
6521 to <tt>ptr</tt>. It yields the original value stored at <tt>ptr</tt>.</p>
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006522
6523<h5>Examples:</h5>
6524<pre>
6525%ptr = malloc i32
6526 store i32 4, %ptr
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006527%result1 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.add.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 4 )
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006528 <i>; yields {i32}:result1 = 4</i>
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006529%result2 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.add.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 2 )
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006530 <i>; yields {i32}:result2 = 8</i>
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006531%result3 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.add.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 5 )
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006532 <i>; yields {i32}:result3 = 10</i>
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006533%memval1 = load i32* %ptr <i>; yields {i32}:memval1 = 15</i>
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006534</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006535
Andrew Lenharthab0b9492008-02-21 06:45:13 +00006536</div>
6537
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006538<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6539<div class="doc_subsubsection">
6540 <a name="int_atomic_load_sub">'<tt>llvm.atomic.load.sub.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
6541
6542</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006543
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006544<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006545
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006546<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006547<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use <tt>llvm.atomic.load.sub</tt> on
6548 any integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
6549 support all bit widths however.</p>
6550
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006551<pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006552 declare i8 @llvm.atomic.load.sub.i8.p0i32( i8* &lt;ptr&gt;, i8 &lt;delta&gt; )
6553 declare i16 @llvm.atomic.load.sub.i16.p0i32( i16* &lt;ptr&gt;, i16 &lt;delta&gt; )
6554 declare i32 @llvm.atomic.load.sub.i32.p0i32( i32* &lt;ptr&gt;, i32 &lt;delta&gt; )
6555 declare i64 @llvm.atomic.load.sub.i64.p0i32( i64* &lt;ptr&gt;, i64 &lt;delta&gt; )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006556</pre>
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006557
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006558<h5>Overview:</h5>
6559<p>This intrinsic subtracts <tt>delta</tt> to the value stored in memory at
6560 <tt>ptr</tt>. It yields the original value at <tt>ptr</tt>.</p>
6561
6562<h5>Arguments:</h5>
6563<p>The intrinsic takes two arguments, the first a pointer to an integer value
6564 and the second an integer value. The result is also an integer value. These
6565 integer types can have any bit width, but they must all have the same bit
6566 width. The targets may only lower integer representations they support.</p>
6567
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006568<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006569<p>This intrinsic does a series of operations atomically. It first loads the
6570 value stored at <tt>ptr</tt>. It then subtracts <tt>delta</tt>, stores the
6571 result to <tt>ptr</tt>. It yields the original value stored
6572 at <tt>ptr</tt>.</p>
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006573
6574<h5>Examples:</h5>
6575<pre>
6576%ptr = malloc i32
6577 store i32 8, %ptr
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006578%result1 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.sub.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 4 )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006579 <i>; yields {i32}:result1 = 8</i>
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006580%result2 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.sub.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 2 )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006581 <i>; yields {i32}:result2 = 4</i>
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006582%result3 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.sub.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 5 )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006583 <i>; yields {i32}:result3 = 2</i>
6584%memval1 = load i32* %ptr <i>; yields {i32}:memval1 = -3</i>
6585</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006586
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006587</div>
6588
6589<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6590<div class="doc_subsubsection">
6591 <a name="int_atomic_load_and">'<tt>llvm.atomic.load.and.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a><br>
6592 <a name="int_atomic_load_nand">'<tt>llvm.atomic.load.nand.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a><br>
6593 <a name="int_atomic_load_or">'<tt>llvm.atomic.load.or.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a><br>
6594 <a name="int_atomic_load_xor">'<tt>llvm.atomic.load.xor.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a><br>
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006595</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006596
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006597<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006598
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006599<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006600<p>These are overloaded intrinsics. You can
6601 use <tt>llvm.atomic.load_and</tt>, <tt>llvm.atomic.load_nand</tt>,
6602 <tt>llvm.atomic.load_or</tt>, and <tt>llvm.atomic.load_xor</tt> on any integer
6603 bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets support all bit
6604 widths however.</p>
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006605
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006606<pre>
6607 declare i8 @llvm.atomic.load.and.i8.p0i8( i8* &lt;ptr&gt;, i8 &lt;delta&gt; )
6608 declare i16 @llvm.atomic.load.and.i16.p0i16( i16* &lt;ptr&gt;, i16 &lt;delta&gt; )
6609 declare i32 @llvm.atomic.load.and.i32.p0i32( i32* &lt;ptr&gt;, i32 &lt;delta&gt; )
6610 declare i64 @llvm.atomic.load.and.i64.p0i64( i64* &lt;ptr&gt;, i64 &lt;delta&gt; )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006611</pre>
6612
6613<pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006614 declare i8 @llvm.atomic.load.or.i8.p0i8( i8* &lt;ptr&gt;, i8 &lt;delta&gt; )
6615 declare i16 @llvm.atomic.load.or.i16.p0i16( i16* &lt;ptr&gt;, i16 &lt;delta&gt; )
6616 declare i32 @llvm.atomic.load.or.i32.p0i32( i32* &lt;ptr&gt;, i32 &lt;delta&gt; )
6617 declare i64 @llvm.atomic.load.or.i64.p0i64( i64* &lt;ptr&gt;, i64 &lt;delta&gt; )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006618</pre>
6619
6620<pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006621 declare i8 @llvm.atomic.load.nand.i8.p0i32( i8* &lt;ptr&gt;, i8 &lt;delta&gt; )
6622 declare i16 @llvm.atomic.load.nand.i16.p0i32( i16* &lt;ptr&gt;, i16 &lt;delta&gt; )
6623 declare i32 @llvm.atomic.load.nand.i32.p0i32( i32* &lt;ptr&gt;, i32 &lt;delta&gt; )
6624 declare i64 @llvm.atomic.load.nand.i64.p0i32( i64* &lt;ptr&gt;, i64 &lt;delta&gt; )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006625</pre>
6626
6627<pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006628 declare i8 @llvm.atomic.load.xor.i8.p0i32( i8* &lt;ptr&gt;, i8 &lt;delta&gt; )
6629 declare i16 @llvm.atomic.load.xor.i16.p0i32( i16* &lt;ptr&gt;, i16 &lt;delta&gt; )
6630 declare i32 @llvm.atomic.load.xor.i32.p0i32( i32* &lt;ptr&gt;, i32 &lt;delta&gt; )
6631 declare i64 @llvm.atomic.load.xor.i64.p0i32( i64* &lt;ptr&gt;, i64 &lt;delta&gt; )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006632</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006633
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006634<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006635<p>These intrinsics bitwise the operation (and, nand, or, xor) <tt>delta</tt> to
6636 the value stored in memory at <tt>ptr</tt>. It yields the original value
6637 at <tt>ptr</tt>.</p>
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006638
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006639<h5>Arguments:</h5>
6640<p>These intrinsics take two arguments, the first a pointer to an integer value
6641 and the second an integer value. The result is also an integer value. These
6642 integer types can have any bit width, but they must all have the same bit
6643 width. The targets may only lower integer representations they support.</p>
6644
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006645<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006646<p>These intrinsics does a series of operations atomically. They first load the
6647 value stored at <tt>ptr</tt>. They then do the bitwise
6648 operation <tt>delta</tt>, store the result to <tt>ptr</tt>. They yield the
6649 original value stored at <tt>ptr</tt>.</p>
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006650
6651<h5>Examples:</h5>
6652<pre>
6653%ptr = malloc i32
6654 store i32 0x0F0F, %ptr
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006655%result0 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.nand.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 0xFF )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006656 <i>; yields {i32}:result0 = 0x0F0F</i>
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006657%result1 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.and.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 0xFF )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006658 <i>; yields {i32}:result1 = 0xFFFFFFF0</i>
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006659%result2 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.or.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 0F )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006660 <i>; yields {i32}:result2 = 0xF0</i>
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006661%result3 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.xor.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 0F )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006662 <i>; yields {i32}:result3 = FF</i>
6663%memval1 = load i32* %ptr <i>; yields {i32}:memval1 = F0</i>
6664</pre>
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006665
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006666</div>
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006667
6668<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6669<div class="doc_subsubsection">
6670 <a name="int_atomic_load_max">'<tt>llvm.atomic.load.max.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a><br>
6671 <a name="int_atomic_load_min">'<tt>llvm.atomic.load.min.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a><br>
6672 <a name="int_atomic_load_umax">'<tt>llvm.atomic.load.umax.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a><br>
6673 <a name="int_atomic_load_umin">'<tt>llvm.atomic.load.umin.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a><br>
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006674</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006675
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006676<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006677
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006678<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006679<p>These are overloaded intrinsics. You can use <tt>llvm.atomic.load_max</tt>,
6680 <tt>llvm.atomic.load_min</tt>, <tt>llvm.atomic.load_umax</tt>, and
6681 <tt>llvm.atomic.load_umin</tt> on any integer bit width and for different
6682 address spaces. Not all targets support all bit widths however.</p>
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006683
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006684<pre>
6685 declare i8 @llvm.atomic.load.max.i8.p0i8( i8* &lt;ptr&gt;, i8 &lt;delta&gt; )
6686 declare i16 @llvm.atomic.load.max.i16.p0i16( i16* &lt;ptr&gt;, i16 &lt;delta&gt; )
6687 declare i32 @llvm.atomic.load.max.i32.p0i32( i32* &lt;ptr&gt;, i32 &lt;delta&gt; )
6688 declare i64 @llvm.atomic.load.max.i64.p0i64( i64* &lt;ptr&gt;, i64 &lt;delta&gt; )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006689</pre>
6690
6691<pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006692 declare i8 @llvm.atomic.load.min.i8.p0i8( i8* &lt;ptr&gt;, i8 &lt;delta&gt; )
6693 declare i16 @llvm.atomic.load.min.i16.p0i16( i16* &lt;ptr&gt;, i16 &lt;delta&gt; )
6694 declare i32 @llvm.atomic.load.min.i32..p0i32( i32* &lt;ptr&gt;, i32 &lt;delta&gt; )
6695 declare i64 @llvm.atomic.load.min.i64..p0i64( i64* &lt;ptr&gt;, i64 &lt;delta&gt; )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006696</pre>
6697
6698<pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006699 declare i8 @llvm.atomic.load.umax.i8.p0i8( i8* &lt;ptr&gt;, i8 &lt;delta&gt; )
6700 declare i16 @llvm.atomic.load.umax.i16.p0i16( i16* &lt;ptr&gt;, i16 &lt;delta&gt; )
6701 declare i32 @llvm.atomic.load.umax.i32.p0i32( i32* &lt;ptr&gt;, i32 &lt;delta&gt; )
6702 declare i64 @llvm.atomic.load.umax.i64.p0i64( i64* &lt;ptr&gt;, i64 &lt;delta&gt; )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006703</pre>
6704
6705<pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006706 declare i8 @llvm.atomic.load.umin.i8..p0i8( i8* &lt;ptr&gt;, i8 &lt;delta&gt; )
6707 declare i16 @llvm.atomic.load.umin.i16.p0i16( i16* &lt;ptr&gt;, i16 &lt;delta&gt; )
6708 declare i32 @llvm.atomic.load.umin.i32..p0i32( i32* &lt;ptr&gt;, i32 &lt;delta&gt; )
6709 declare i64 @llvm.atomic.load.umin.i64..p0i64( i64* &lt;ptr&gt;, i64 &lt;delta&gt; )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006710</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006711
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006712<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006713<p>These intrinsics takes the signed or unsigned minimum or maximum of
6714 <tt>delta</tt> and the value stored in memory at <tt>ptr</tt>. It yields the
6715 original value at <tt>ptr</tt>.</p>
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006716
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006717<h5>Arguments:</h5>
6718<p>These intrinsics take two arguments, the first a pointer to an integer value
6719 and the second an integer value. The result is also an integer value. These
6720 integer types can have any bit width, but they must all have the same bit
6721 width. The targets may only lower integer representations they support.</p>
6722
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006723<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006724<p>These intrinsics does a series of operations atomically. They first load the
6725 value stored at <tt>ptr</tt>. They then do the signed or unsigned min or
6726 max <tt>delta</tt> and the value, store the result to <tt>ptr</tt>. They
6727 yield the original value stored at <tt>ptr</tt>.</p>
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006728
6729<h5>Examples:</h5>
6730<pre>
6731%ptr = malloc i32
6732 store i32 7, %ptr
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006733%result0 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.min.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 -2 )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006734 <i>; yields {i32}:result0 = 7</i>
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006735%result1 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.max.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 8 )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006736 <i>; yields {i32}:result1 = -2</i>
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006737%result2 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.umin.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 10 )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006738 <i>; yields {i32}:result2 = 8</i>
Mon P Wange3b3a722008-07-30 04:36:53 +00006739%result3 = call i32 @llvm.atomic.load.umax.i32.p0i32( i32* %ptr, i32 30 )
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006740 <i>; yields {i32}:result3 = 8</i>
6741%memval1 = load i32* %ptr <i>; yields {i32}:memval1 = 30</i>
6742</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006743
Mon P Wang28873102008-06-25 08:15:39 +00006744</div>
Andrew Lenharth22c5c1b2008-02-16 01:24:58 +00006745
6746<!-- ======================================================================= -->
6747<div class="doc_subsection">
Tanya Lattner6d806e92007-06-15 20:50:54 +00006748 <a name="int_general">General Intrinsics</a>
6749</div>
6750
6751<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006752
6753<p>This class of intrinsics is designed to be generic and has no specific
6754 purpose.</p>
6755
Tanya Lattner6d806e92007-06-15 20:50:54 +00006756</div>
6757
6758<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6759<div class="doc_subsubsection">
6760 <a name="int_var_annotation">'<tt>llvm.var.annotation</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
6761</div>
6762
6763<div class="doc_text">
6764
6765<h5>Syntax:</h5>
6766<pre>
Tanya Lattnerd2e84422007-06-18 23:42:37 +00006767 declare void @llvm.var.annotation(i8* &lt;val&gt;, i8* &lt;str&gt;, i8* &lt;str&gt;, i32 &lt;int&gt; )
Tanya Lattner6d806e92007-06-15 20:50:54 +00006768</pre>
6769
6770<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006771<p>The '<tt>llvm.var.annotation</tt>' intrinsic.</p>
Tanya Lattner6d806e92007-06-15 20:50:54 +00006772
6773<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006774<p>The first argument is a pointer to a value, the second is a pointer to a
6775 global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the source
6776 file name, and the last argument is the line number.</p>
Tanya Lattner6d806e92007-06-15 20:50:54 +00006777
6778<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006779<p>This intrinsic allows annotation of local variables with arbitrary strings.
6780 This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look for
6781 these annotations. These have no other defined use, they are ignored by code
6782 generation and optimization.</p>
Tanya Lattner6d806e92007-06-15 20:50:54 +00006783
Tanya Lattner6d806e92007-06-15 20:50:54 +00006784</div>
6785
Tanya Lattnerb6367882007-09-21 22:59:12 +00006786<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6787<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Tanya Lattnere1a8da02007-09-21 23:57:59 +00006788 <a name="int_annotation">'<tt>llvm.annotation.*</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Tanya Lattnerb6367882007-09-21 22:59:12 +00006789</div>
6790
6791<div class="doc_text">
6792
6793<h5>Syntax:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006794<p>This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '<tt>llvm.annotation</tt>' on
6795 any integer bit width.</p>
6796
Tanya Lattnerb6367882007-09-21 22:59:12 +00006797<pre>
Tanya Lattnerd3989a82007-09-22 00:03:01 +00006798 declare i8 @llvm.annotation.i8(i8 &lt;val&gt;, i8* &lt;str&gt;, i8* &lt;str&gt;, i32 &lt;int&gt; )
6799 declare i16 @llvm.annotation.i16(i16 &lt;val&gt;, i8* &lt;str&gt;, i8* &lt;str&gt;, i32 &lt;int&gt; )
6800 declare i32 @llvm.annotation.i32(i32 &lt;val&gt;, i8* &lt;str&gt;, i8* &lt;str&gt;, i32 &lt;int&gt; )
6801 declare i64 @llvm.annotation.i64(i64 &lt;val&gt;, i8* &lt;str&gt;, i8* &lt;str&gt;, i32 &lt;int&gt; )
6802 declare i256 @llvm.annotation.i256(i256 &lt;val&gt;, i8* &lt;str&gt;, i8* &lt;str&gt;, i32 &lt;int&gt; )
Tanya Lattnerb6367882007-09-21 22:59:12 +00006803</pre>
6804
6805<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006806<p>The '<tt>llvm.annotation</tt>' intrinsic.</p>
Tanya Lattnerb6367882007-09-21 22:59:12 +00006807
6808<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006809<p>The first argument is an integer value (result of some expression), the
6810 second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a global
6811 string which is the source file name, and the last argument is the line
6812 number. It returns the value of the first argument.</p>
Tanya Lattnerb6367882007-09-21 22:59:12 +00006813
6814<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006815<p>This intrinsic allows annotations to be put on arbitrary expressions with
6816 arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that
6817 want to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use, they
6818 are ignored by code generation and optimization.</p>
Tanya Lattnerb6367882007-09-21 22:59:12 +00006819
Tanya Lattnerb6367882007-09-21 22:59:12 +00006820</div>
Jim Laskeydd4ef1b2007-03-14 19:31:19 +00006821
Anton Korobeynikov4cb86182008-01-15 22:31:34 +00006822<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6823<div class="doc_subsubsection">
6824 <a name="int_trap">'<tt>llvm.trap</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
6825</div>
6826
6827<div class="doc_text">
6828
6829<h5>Syntax:</h5>
6830<pre>
6831 declare void @llvm.trap()
6832</pre>
6833
6834<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006835<p>The '<tt>llvm.trap</tt>' intrinsic.</p>
Anton Korobeynikov4cb86182008-01-15 22:31:34 +00006836
6837<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006838<p>None.</p>
Anton Korobeynikov4cb86182008-01-15 22:31:34 +00006839
6840<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006841<p>This intrinsics is lowered to the target dependent trap instruction. If the
6842 target does not have a trap instruction, this intrinsic will be lowered to
6843 the call of the <tt>abort()</tt> function.</p>
Anton Korobeynikov4cb86182008-01-15 22:31:34 +00006844
Anton Korobeynikov4cb86182008-01-15 22:31:34 +00006845</div>
6846
Bill Wendling69e4adb2008-11-19 05:56:17 +00006847<!-- _______________________________________________________________________ -->
6848<div class="doc_subsubsection">
Misha Brukmandccb0252008-11-22 23:55:29 +00006849 <a name="int_stackprotector">'<tt>llvm.stackprotector</tt>' Intrinsic</a>
Bill Wendling69e4adb2008-11-19 05:56:17 +00006850</div>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006851
Bill Wendling69e4adb2008-11-19 05:56:17 +00006852<div class="doc_text">
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006853
Bill Wendling69e4adb2008-11-19 05:56:17 +00006854<h5>Syntax:</h5>
6855<pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006856 declare void @llvm.stackprotector( i8* &lt;guard&gt;, i8** &lt;slot&gt; )
Bill Wendling69e4adb2008-11-19 05:56:17 +00006857</pre>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006858
Bill Wendling69e4adb2008-11-19 05:56:17 +00006859<h5>Overview:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006860<p>The <tt>llvm.stackprotector</tt> intrinsic takes the <tt>guard</tt> and
6861 stores it onto the stack at <tt>slot</tt>. The stack slot is adjusted to
6862 ensure that it is placed on the stack before local variables.</p>
6863
Bill Wendling69e4adb2008-11-19 05:56:17 +00006864<h5>Arguments:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006865<p>The <tt>llvm.stackprotector</tt> intrinsic requires two pointer
6866 arguments. The first argument is the value loaded from the stack
6867 guard <tt>@__stack_chk_guard</tt>. The second variable is an <tt>alloca</tt>
6868 that has enough space to hold the value of the guard.</p>
6869
Bill Wendling69e4adb2008-11-19 05:56:17 +00006870<h5>Semantics:</h5>
Bill Wendlinge910b4c2009-07-20 02:29:24 +00006871<p>This intrinsic causes the prologue/epilogue inserter to force the position of
6872 the <tt>AllocaInst</tt> stack slot to be before local variables on the
6873 stack. This is to ensure that if a local variable on the stack is
6874 overwritten, it will destroy the value of the guard. When the function exits,
6875 the guard on the stack is checked against the original guard. If they're
6876 different, then the program aborts by calling the <tt>__stack_chk_fail()</tt>
6877 function.</p>
6878
Bill Wendling69e4adb2008-11-19 05:56:17 +00006879</div>
6880
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00006881<!-- *********************************************************************** -->
Chris Lattner00950542001-06-06 20:29:01 +00006882<hr>
Misha Brukmandaa4cb02004-03-01 17:47:27 +00006883<address>
6884 <a href="http://jigsaw.w3.org/css-validator/check/referer"><img
Misha Brukman44408702008-12-11 17:34:48 +00006885 src="http://jigsaw.w3.org/css-validator/images/vcss-blue" alt="Valid CSS"></a>
Misha Brukmandaa4cb02004-03-01 17:47:27 +00006886 <a href="http://validator.w3.org/check/referer"><img
Misha Brukman44408702008-12-11 17:34:48 +00006887 src="http://www.w3.org/Icons/valid-html401-blue" alt="Valid HTML 4.01"></a>
Misha Brukmandaa4cb02004-03-01 17:47:27 +00006888
6889 <a href="mailto:sabre@nondot.org">Chris Lattner</a><br>
Reid Spencer05fe4b02006-03-14 05:39:39 +00006890 <a href="http://llvm.org">The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure</a><br>
Misha Brukmandaa4cb02004-03-01 17:47:27 +00006891 Last modified: $Date$
6892</address>
Chris Lattnerc7d3ab32008-01-04 04:33:49 +00006893
Misha Brukman9d0919f2003-11-08 01:05:38 +00006894</body>
6895</html>